tm.texi.in (CLASS_MAX_NREGS): Fix typo.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
5 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7 @node Target Macros
8 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9 @cindex machine description macros
10 @cindex target description macros
11 @cindex macros, target description
12 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28 @menu
29 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59 * Misc:: Everything else.
60 @end menu
61
62 @node Target Structure
63 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64 @cindex target hooks
65 @cindex target functions
66
67 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75 @smallexample
76 #include "target.h"
77 #include "target-def.h"
78
79 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85 @end smallexample
86 @end deftypevar
87
88 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92 @code{targetm} structure.
93
94 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
97 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
98 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
102 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110 default definition is used.
111
112 @node Driver
113 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114 @cindex driver
115 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117 @c prevent bad page break with this line
118 You can control the compilation driver.
119
120 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133 that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136 @end defmac
137
138 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148 everywhere it occurs.
149
150 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155 @end defmac
156
157 @defmac CPP_SPEC
158 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163 @end defmac
164
165 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169 @end defmac
170
171 @defmac CC1_SPEC
172 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174 front ends.
175 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176 for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179 @end defmac
180
181 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
184 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190 @end defmac
191
192 @defmac ASM_SPEC
193 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
195 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199 @end defmac
200
201 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205 an example of this.
206
207 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208 @end defmac
209
210 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221 @end defmac
222
223 @defmac LINK_SPEC
224 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
226 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229 @end defmac
230
231 @defmac LIB_SPEC
232 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234 command given to the linker.
235
236 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
238 @end defmac
239
240 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248 @end defmac
249
250 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
256 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260 @end defmac
261
262 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268 @end defmac
269
270 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275 @end defmac
276
277 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
284 @end defmac
285
286 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289 the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292 @end defmac
293
294 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302 @end defmac
303
304 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308 @end defmac
309
310 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
313 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315 @end defmac
316
317 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324 string constant that provides the specification.
325
326 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331 these definitions.
332
333 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336 used.
337
338 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340 @smallexample
341 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345 @end smallexample
346
347 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348 @smallexample
349 #undef CPP_SPEC
350 #define CPP_SPEC \
351 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358 @end smallexample
359
360 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363 @smallexample
364 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366 @end smallexample
367 @end defmac
368
369 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373 @end defmac
374
375 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378 @end defmac
379
380 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388 @end defmac
389
390 @defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
391 A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
392 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
393 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
394 @end defmac
395
396 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
397 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
398 @end deftypevr
399
400 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
401 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
402 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
403 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
404 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
405
406 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
407 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
408 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
409 @xref{Target Fragment}.
410 @end defmac
411
412 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
413 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
414 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
415 indicates an absolute file name.
416 @end defmac
417
418 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
419 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
420 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
421 when the compiler is built as a cross
422 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
423 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
424 @end defmac
425
426 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
427 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
429 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
431 is built as a cross compiler.
432 @end defmac
433
434 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
435 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
436 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
437 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
438 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
439 is built as a cross compiler.
440 @end defmac
441
442 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
443 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
444 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
445 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
446 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
447 is built as a cross compiler.
448 @end defmac
449
450 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
451 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
452 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
453 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
454 @end defmac
455
456 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
457 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
458 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
459 cross compiler.
460 @end defmac
461
462 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
463 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
464 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
465 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
466 initialize the necessary environment variables.
467 @end defmac
468
469 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
470 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
471 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
472 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
473 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
474
475 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
476 replacement.
477 @end defmac
478
479 @defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
480 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
481 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
482 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
483 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
484
485 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
486 specified.
487 @end defmac
488
489 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
490 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
491 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
492 try when searching for header files.
493
494 Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
495 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
496 @end defmac
497
498 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
499 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
500 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
501 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
502 @end defmac
503
504 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
505 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
506 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
507 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
508 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
509 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
510 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
511 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
512 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
513
514 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
515 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
516 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
517 for C++-only directories,
518 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
519 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
520 the array with a null element.
521
522 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
523 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
524 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
525 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
526
527 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
528
529 @smallexample
530 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
531 @{ \
532 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
533 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
534 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
535 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
536 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
537 @}
538 @end smallexample
539 @end defmac
540
541 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
542
543 @enumerate
544 @item
545 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
546
547 @item
548 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
549 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
550 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
551
552 @item
553 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
554
555 @item
556 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
557 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
558
559 @item
560 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
561
562 @item
563 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
564
565 @item
566 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
567 compiler.
568 @end enumerate
569
570 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
571
572 @enumerate
573 @item
574 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
575
576 @item
577 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
578 value based on the installed toolchain location.
579
580 @item
581 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
582 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
583
584 @item
585 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
586 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
587
588 @item
589 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
590
591 @item
592 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
593 compiler.
594
595 @item
596 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
597 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
598
599 @item
600 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
601 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
602
603 @item
604 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
605 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
606 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
607
608 @item
609 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
610 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
611 @file{/lib/}.
612
613 @item
614 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
615 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
616 @file{/usr/lib/}.
617 @end enumerate
618
619 @node Run-time Target
620 @section Run-time Target Specification
621 @cindex run-time target specification
622 @cindex predefined macros
623 @cindex target specifications
624
625 @c prevent bad page break with this line
626 Here are run-time target specifications.
627
628 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
629 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
630 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
631 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
632 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
633 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
634 finished command line option processing your code can use those
635 results freely.
636
637 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
638 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
639 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
640 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
641
642 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
643 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
644 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
645 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
646 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
647 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
648 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
649 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
650 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
651 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
652
653 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
654 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
655 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
656 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
657 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
658 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
659 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
660 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
661 preprocessing.
662 @end defmac
663
664 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
665 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
666 and is used for the target operating system instead.
667 @end defmac
668
669 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
670 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
671 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
672 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
673 it yourself.
674 @end defmac
675
676 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
677 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
678 any target-specific headers.
679 @end deftypevar
680
681 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
682 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
683 Its default setting is 0.
684 @end deftypevr
685
686 @cindex optional hardware or system features
687 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
688
689 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
690 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
691 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
692 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
693 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
694 definition does nothing but return true.
695
696 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
697 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
698 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
699 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
700 via attributes).
701 @end deftypefn
702
703 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
704 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
705 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
706 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
707 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
708 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
709 default definition does nothing but return false.
710
711 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
712 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
713 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
714 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
715 @end deftypefn
716
717 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
718 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
719 @end deftypefn
720
721 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
722 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
723 @end deftypefn
724
725 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
726 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
727 @end deftypefn
728
729 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
730 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
731 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
732 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
733 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
734 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
735 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
736 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
737 @end deftypefn
738
739 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
740 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
741 but is only used in the C
742 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
743 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
744 frontends.
745 @end defmac
746
747 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
748 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
749 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
750 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
751 options are processed once
752 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
753 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
754 options passed explicitly.
755
756 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
757 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
758 @code{optimize} attribute.
759 @end deftypevr
760
761 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
762 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
763 @end deftypefn
764
765 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
766 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
767 @end deftypefn
768
769 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
770 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
771 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
772 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
773 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
774 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
775
776 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
777 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
778 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
779 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
780 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
781 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
782 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
783
784 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
785 is 0.
786 @end defmac
787
788 @node Per-Function Data
789 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
790 @cindex per-function data
791 @cindex data structures
792
793 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
794 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
795 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
796 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
797 when another one comes along.
798
799 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
800 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
801 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
802 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
803 to their own specific data.
804
805 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
806 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
807 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
808 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
809
810 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
811 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
812 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
813 function, for level 0.
814
815 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
816 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
817 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
818 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
819 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
820 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
821 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
822 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
823 longer supported.
824
825 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
826 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
827 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
828 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
829 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
830 @end defmac
831
832 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
833 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
834 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
835 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
836 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
837 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
838
839 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
840 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
841 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
842 @end deftypevar
843
844 @node Storage Layout
845 @section Storage Layout
846 @cindex storage layout
847
848 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
849 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
850 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
851 @xref{Run-time Target}.
852
853 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
854 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
855 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
856 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
857 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
858 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
859 macro need not be a constant.
860
861 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
862 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
863 @end defmac
864
865 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
866 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
867 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
868 @end defmac
869
870 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
871 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
872 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
873 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
874 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
875 macro need not be a constant.
876 @end defmac
877
878 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
879 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
880 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
881 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
882 the order of words in memory.
883 @end defmac
884
885 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
886 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
887 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
888 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
889 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
890
891 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
892 multi-word integers.
893 @end defmac
894
895 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
896 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
897 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
898 @end defmac
899
900 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
901 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
902 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
903 @end defmac
904
905 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
906 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
907 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
908 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
909 @end defmac
910
911 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
912 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
913 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
914 @end defmac
915
916 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
917 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
918 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
919 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
920 @end defmac
921
922 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
923 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
924 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
925 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
926 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
927 @end defmac
928
929 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
930 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
931 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
932 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
933 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
934 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
935 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
936
937 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
938 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
939 @end defmac
940
941 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
942 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
943 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
944 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
945 scalar type.
946
947 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
948 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
949 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
950 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
951 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
952 counterparts.
953
954 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
955 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
956 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
957 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
958 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
959 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
960
961 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
962 @end defmac
963
964 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
965 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
966 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
967 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
968 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
969 pointer} types.
970
971 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
972 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
973 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
974 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
975 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
976 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
977 the signedness may be different.
978
979 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
980
981 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
982 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
983 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
984 @end deftypefn
985
986 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
987 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
988 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
989 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
990 size of an integer.
991 @end defmac
992
993 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
994 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
995 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
996 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
997 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
998 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
999 @end defmac
1000
1001 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1002 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1003 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
1004 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1005 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1006 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1007 @end defmac
1008
1009 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1010 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1011 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1012 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1013 @end defmac
1014
1015 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1016 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1017 @end defmac
1018
1019 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1020 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1021 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1022 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1023 @end defmac
1024
1025 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1026 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1027 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1028 @end defmac
1029
1030 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1031 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1032 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1033 @end defmac
1034
1035 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1036 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1037 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1038 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1039 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1040 @end defmac
1041
1042 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1043 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1044 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1045 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1046 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1047 @end defmac
1048
1049 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1050 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1051 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1052 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1053 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1054 field alignment has not been set by the
1055 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1056 @end defmac
1057
1058 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1059 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1060 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1061
1062 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1063
1064 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1065 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1066 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1067 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1068 @end defmac
1069
1070 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1071 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1072 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1073 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1074 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1075
1076 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1077 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1078 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1079 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1080 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1081 @end defmac
1082
1083 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1084 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1085 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1086 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1087 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1088
1089 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1090
1091 @findex strcpy
1092 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1093 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1094 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1095 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1096 @end defmac
1097
1098 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1099 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1100 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1101 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1102 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1103 align the object.
1104
1105 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1106
1107 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1108 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1109 constants can be done inline.
1110 @end defmac
1111
1112 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1113 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1114 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1115 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1116 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1117
1118 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1119
1120 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1121 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1122
1123 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1124 @end defmac
1125
1126 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1127 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1128 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1129 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1130 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1131 align the slot.
1132
1133 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1134 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1135 be used.
1136
1137 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1138 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1139
1140 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1141 @end defmac
1142
1143 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1144 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1145 variable @var{decl}.
1146
1147 If this macro is not defined, then
1148 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1149 is used.
1150
1151 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1152 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1153
1154 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1155 @end defmac
1156
1157 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1158 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1159 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1160 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1161
1162 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1163 @end defmac
1164
1165 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1166 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1167 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1168
1169 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1170 @end defmac
1171
1172 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1173 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1174 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1175
1176 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1177 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1178 @end defmac
1179
1180 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1181 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1182 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1183 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1184 @end defmac
1185
1186 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1187 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1188 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1189
1190 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1191 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1192 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1193 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1194 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1195
1196 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1197 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1198 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1199 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1200
1201 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1202 structure.
1203
1204 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1205 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1206
1207 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1208 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1209 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1210 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1211
1212 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1213 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1214 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1215
1216 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1217 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1218 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1219
1220 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1221 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1222 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1223
1224 @smallexample
1225 struct foo1
1226 @{
1227 char x;
1228 char :0;
1229 char y;
1230 @};
1231
1232 struct foo2
1233 @{
1234 char x;
1235 int :0;
1236 char y;
1237 @};
1238
1239 main ()
1240 @{
1241 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1242 sizeof (struct foo1));
1243 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1244 sizeof (struct foo2));
1245 exit (0);
1246 @}
1247 @end smallexample
1248
1249 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1250 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1251 @end defmac
1252
1253 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1254 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1255 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1256 @end defmac
1257
1258 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1259 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1260 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1261 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1262 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1263 @end deftypefn
1264
1265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1266 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1267 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1268 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1269
1270 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1271 @end deftypefn
1272
1273 @defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1274 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1275 @code{BLKMODE}.
1276
1277 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1278 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1279 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1280 retain the field's mode.
1281
1282 Normally, this is not needed.
1283 @end defmac
1284
1285 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1286 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1287 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1288 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1289 @var{specified}.
1290
1291 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1292 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1293 @end defmac
1294
1295 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1296 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1297 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1298 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1299 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1300 (DImode)} is assumed.
1301 @end defmac
1302
1303 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1304 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1305 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1306 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1307 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1308 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1309 having its mode specified.
1310
1311 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1312 would most commonly define this macro if the
1313 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1314 64-bit mode.
1315 @end defmac
1316
1317 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1318 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1319 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1320 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1321
1322 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1323 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1324 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1325 @end defmac
1326
1327 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1328 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1329 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1330 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1331 targets.
1332 @end deftypefn
1333
1334 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1335 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1336 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1337 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1338 targets.
1339 @end deftypefn
1340
1341 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1342 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1343 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1344 @end deftypefn
1345
1346 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1347 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1348 mode is towards zero.
1349
1350 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1351 floating-point arithmetic.
1352
1353 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1354 @end defmac
1355
1356 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1357 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1358 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1359 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1360
1361 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1362 floating-point arithmetic.
1363
1364 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1365 @end defmac
1366
1367 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1368 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1369 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1370 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1371 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1372 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1373 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1374 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1375 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1376 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1377 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1378 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1379
1380 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1381 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1382 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1383 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1384 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1385 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1386 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1387
1388 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1389 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1390 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1391 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1392 may affect its placement.
1393 @end deftypefn
1394
1395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1396 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1397 @end deftypefn
1398
1399 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1400 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1401 @end deftypefn
1402
1403 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1404 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1405 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1406 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1407 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1408 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1409 usage.
1410 @end deftypefn
1411
1412 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1413 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1414 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1415 @end deftypefn
1416
1417 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1418 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1419 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1420 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1421 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1422 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1423 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1424 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1425 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1426 string constant.
1427
1428 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1429 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1430 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1431 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1432 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1433 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1434 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1435 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1436 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1437 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1438 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1439 spaces in your string.
1440
1441 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1442 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1443 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1444 before mangling.
1445
1446 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1447 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1448 types.
1449 @end deftypefn
1450
1451 @node Type Layout
1452 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1453
1454 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1455 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1456 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1457 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1458
1459 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1460 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1461 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1462 @end defmac
1463
1464 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1465 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1466 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1467 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1468 unit.)
1469 @end defmac
1470
1471 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1472 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1473 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1474 @end defmac
1475
1476 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1477 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1478 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1479 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1480 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1481 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1482 @end defmac
1483
1484 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1485 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1486 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1487 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1488 macro must be at least 64.
1489 @end defmac
1490
1491 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1492 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1493 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1494 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1495 @end defmac
1496
1497 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1498 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1499 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1500 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1501 @end defmac
1502
1503 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1504 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1505 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1506 @end defmac
1507
1508 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1509 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1510 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1511 words.
1512 @end defmac
1513
1514 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1515 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1516 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1517 words.
1518 @end defmac
1519
1520 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1521 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1522 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1524 @end defmac
1525
1526 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1527 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1528 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1530 @end defmac
1531
1532 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1533 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1534 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1536 @end defmac
1537
1538 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1539 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1540 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1541 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1542 @end defmac
1543
1544 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1545 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1546 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1547 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1548 @end defmac
1549
1550 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1551 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1552 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1553 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1554 @end defmac
1555
1556 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1557 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1558 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1559 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1560 @end defmac
1561
1562 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1563 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1564 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1565 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1566 @end defmac
1567
1568 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1569 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1570 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1571 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1572 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1573 @end defmac
1574
1575 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1576 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1577 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1578 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1579 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1580 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1581 otherwise it is 0.
1582 @end defmac
1583
1584 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1585 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1586 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1587 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1588 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1589 @end defmac
1590
1591 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1592 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1593 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1594 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1595 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1596 @end defmac
1597
1598 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1599 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1600 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1601 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1602 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1603 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1604 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1605 @end defmac
1606
1607 @defmac SF_SIZE
1608 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1609 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1610 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1611 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1612 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1613 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1614 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1615 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1616 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1617 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1618 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1619 @end defmac
1620
1621 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1622 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1623 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1624 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1625 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1626 @end defmac
1627
1628 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1629 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1630 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1631 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1632 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1633 is the default.
1634 @end defmac
1635
1636 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1637 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1638 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1639 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1640 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1641 @end defmac
1642
1643 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1644 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1645 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1646 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1647 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1648
1649 The default is to return false.
1650 @end deftypefn
1651
1652 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1653 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1654 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1655 contents of the string.
1656
1657 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1658 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1659 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1660 of the data type names defined in the function
1661 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1662 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1663 crash on startup.
1664
1665 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1666 int"}.
1667 @end defmac
1668
1669 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1670 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1671 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1672 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1673 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1674
1675 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1676 @end defmac
1677
1678 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1679 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1680 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1681 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1682 information.
1683
1684 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1685 @end defmac
1686
1687 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1688 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1689 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1690 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1691 @end defmac
1692
1693 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1694 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1695 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1696 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1697 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1698 information.
1699
1700 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1701 @end defmac
1702
1703 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1704 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1705 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1706 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1707 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1708
1709 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1710 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1711 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1712 @end defmac
1713
1714 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1715 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1716 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1717 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1718 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1719
1720 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1721 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1722 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1723 int}.
1724 @end defmac
1725
1726 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1727 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1728 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1729 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1730 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1731 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1732 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1733 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1734 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1735 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1736 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1737 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1738 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1739 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1740 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1741 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1742 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1743 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1744 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1745 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1746 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1747 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1748 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1749 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1750 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1751 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1752 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1753 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1754 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1755 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1756 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1757 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1758 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1759 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1760 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1761 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1762 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1763
1764 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1765 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1766 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1767 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1768 these macros are null pointers.
1769 @end defmac
1770
1771 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1772 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1773 that looks like:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 struct @{
1777 union @{
1778 void (*fn)();
1779 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1780 @};
1781 ptrdiff_t delta;
1782 @};
1783 @end smallexample
1784
1785 @noindent
1786 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1787 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1788 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1789 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1790 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1791 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1792 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1793 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1794
1795 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1796 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1797 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1798 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1799 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1800 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1801 architecture, you should define this macro to
1802 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1803
1804 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1805 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1806 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1807 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1808 @end defmac
1809
1810 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1811 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1812 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1813 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1814 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1815 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1816 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1817
1818 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1819 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1820 @end defmac
1821
1822 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1823 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1824 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1825 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1826 when special alignment is necessary. */
1827 @end defmac
1828
1829 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1830 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1831 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1832 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1833 of words in each data entry.
1834 @end defmac
1835
1836 @node Registers
1837 @section Register Usage
1838 @cindex register usage
1839
1840 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1841 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1842
1843 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1844 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1845 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1846 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1847 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1848
1849 @menu
1850 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1851 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1852 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1853 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1854 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1855 @end menu
1856
1857 @node Register Basics
1858 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1859
1860 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1861 Registers have various characteristics.
1862
1863 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1864 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1865 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1866 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1867 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1868 @end defmac
1869
1870 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1871 @cindex fixed register
1872 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1873 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1874 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1875 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1876 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1877 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1878 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1879
1880 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1881 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1882 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1883
1884 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1885 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1886 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1887 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1888 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1889 @end defmac
1890
1891 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1892 @cindex call-used register
1893 @cindex call-clobbered register
1894 @cindex call-saved register
1895 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1896 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1897 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1898 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1899 function calls.
1900
1901 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1902 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1903 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1904 @end defmac
1905
1906 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1907 @cindex call-used register
1908 @cindex call-clobbered register
1909 @cindex call-saved register
1910 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1911 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1912 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1913 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1914 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1915 @end defmac
1916
1917 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1918 @cindex call-used register
1919 @cindex call-clobbered register
1920 @cindex call-saved register
1921 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1922 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1923 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1924 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1925 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1926 @end defmac
1927
1928 @findex fixed_regs
1929 @findex call_used_regs
1930 @findex global_regs
1931 @findex reg_names
1932 @findex reg_class_contents
1933 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1934 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1935 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1936 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1937 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1938 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1939 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1940 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1941 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1942 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1943 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1944 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1945 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1946 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1947 command options have been applied.
1948
1949 @cindex disabling certain registers
1950 @cindex controlling register usage
1951 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1952 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1953 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1954 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1955 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1956 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1957 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1958
1959 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1960 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1961 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1962 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1963 @end deftypefn
1964
1965 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1966 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1967 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1968 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1969 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1970 outbound register.
1971 @end defmac
1972
1973 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1974 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1975 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1976 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1977 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1978 register.
1979 @end defmac
1980
1981 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1982 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1983 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1984 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1985 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1986 gotos.
1987 @end defmac
1988
1989 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1990 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1991 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1992 @end defmac
1993
1994 @node Allocation Order
1995 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1996 @cindex order of register allocation
1997 @cindex register allocation order
1998
1999 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2000 Registers are allocated in order.
2001
2002 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2003 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2004 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2005 to use them (from most preferred to least).
2006
2007 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2008 (all else being equal).
2009
2010 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2011 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2012 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2013 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2014 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2015 @end defmac
2016
2017 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2018 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2019 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2020
2021 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2022 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2023 register; and so on.
2024
2025 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2026 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2027
2028 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2029 @end defmac
2030
2031 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2032 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2033 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2034 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2035 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2036 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2037 should be defined.
2038 @end defmac
2039
2040 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2041 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2042 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2043 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2044 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2045 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2046 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2047 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2048
2049 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2050 @end defmac
2051
2052 @node Values in Registers
2053 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2054
2055 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2056 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2057 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2058
2059 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2060 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2061 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2062 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2063 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2064 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2065
2066 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2067 definition of this macro is
2068
2069 @smallexample
2070 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2071 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2072 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2073 @end smallexample
2074 @end defmac
2075
2076 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2077 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2078 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2079 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2080 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2081 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2082 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2083
2084 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2085 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2086 nonzero.
2087
2088 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2089 @code{subreg_get_info}
2090 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2091 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2092 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2093 registers and so not be representable.
2094 @end defmac
2095
2096 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2097 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2098 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2099 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2100 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2101 @end defmac
2102
2103 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2104 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2105 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2106 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2107 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2108 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2109 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2110 @end defmac
2111
2112 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2113 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2114 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2115 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2116 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2117
2118 @smallexample
2119 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2120 @end smallexample
2121
2122 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2123 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2124
2125 @cindex register pairs
2126 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2127 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2128 odd register numbers for such modes.
2129
2130 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2131 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2132 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2133 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2134
2135 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2136 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2137 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2138 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2139 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2140 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2141 to be tieable.
2142
2143 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2144 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2145 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2146 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2147 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2148 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2149
2150 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2151 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2152 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2153 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2154 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2155 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2156 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2157 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2158 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2159
2160 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2161 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2162 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2163 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2164 constraints for those instructions.
2165
2166 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2167 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2168 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2169 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2170 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2171 @end defmac
2172
2173 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2174 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2175 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2176
2177 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2178 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2179 handler.
2180
2181 The default is always nonzero.
2182 @end defmac
2183
2184 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2185 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2186 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2187
2188 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2189 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2190 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2191 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2192 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2193 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2194
2195 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2196 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2197 allocation.
2198 @end defmac
2199
2200 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2201 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2202 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2203
2204 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2205 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2206
2207 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2208 @end deftypefn
2209
2210 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2211 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2212 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2213 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2214 @end defmac
2215
2216 @node Leaf Functions
2217 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2218
2219 @cindex leaf functions
2220 @cindex functions, leaf
2221 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2222 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2223 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2224 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2225 normally arrive.
2226
2227 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2228 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2229 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2230 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2231 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2232 functions''.
2233
2234 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2235 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2236 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2237 accomplish this.
2238
2239 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2240 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2241 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2242 function treatment.
2243
2244 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2245 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2246 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2247 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2248 in this vector.
2249
2250 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2251 the treatment of leaf functions.
2252 @end defmac
2253
2254 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2255 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2256 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2257
2258 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2259 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2260 will cause the compiler to abort.
2261
2262 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2263 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2264 this.
2265 @end defmac
2266
2267 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2268 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2269 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2270 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2271 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2272 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2273 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2274 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2275 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2276 functions which only use leaf registers.
2277 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2278 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2279 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2280 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2281 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2282
2283 @node Stack Registers
2284 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2285
2286 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2287 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2288 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2289 stack.
2290
2291 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2292 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2293 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2294 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2295 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2296 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2297 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2298
2299 @defmac STACK_REGS
2300 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2301 @end defmac
2302
2303 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2304 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2305 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2306 @end defmac
2307
2308 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2309 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2310 of the stack.
2311 @end defmac
2312
2313 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2314 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2315 the stack.
2316 @end defmac
2317
2318 @node Register Classes
2319 @section Register Classes
2320 @cindex register class definitions
2321 @cindex class definitions, register
2322
2323 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2324 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2325 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2326 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2327
2328 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2329 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2330 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2331
2332 @findex ALL_REGS
2333 @findex NO_REGS
2334 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2335 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2336 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2337 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2338
2339 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2340 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2341 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2342 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2343 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2344 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2345
2346 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2347 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2348
2349 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2350 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2351 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2352 them in operand constraints.
2353
2354 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2355 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2356 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2357 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2358 (@pxref{Costs}).
2359
2360 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2361 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2362 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2363 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2364 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2365 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2366 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2367
2368 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2369 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2370 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2371 in their union.
2372
2373 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2374 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2375 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2376 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2377 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2378
2379 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2380 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2381 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2382 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2383 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2384 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2385 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2386 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2387 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2388
2389 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2390 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2391 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2392 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2393 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2394 tells how many classes there are.
2395
2396 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2397 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2398 in many of the tables described below.
2399 @end deftp
2400
2401 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2402 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2403
2404 @smallexample
2405 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2406 @end smallexample
2407 @end defmac
2408
2409 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2410 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2411 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2412 @end defmac
2413
2414 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2415 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2416 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2417 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2418 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2419
2420 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2421 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2422 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2423 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2424 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2425 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2426 so on.
2427 @end defmac
2428
2429 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2430 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2431 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2432 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2433 register.
2434 @end defmac
2435
2436 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2437 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2438 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2439 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2440 @end defmac
2441
2442 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2443 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2444 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2445 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2446 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2447 @end defmac
2448
2449 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2450 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2451 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2452 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2453 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2454 @end defmac
2455
2456 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2457 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2458 base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2459 context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2460 the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2461 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2462 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2463 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2464 @end defmac
2465
2466 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2467 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2468 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2469 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2470 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2471 @end defmac
2472
2473 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2474 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2475 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2476 @end defmac
2477
2478 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2479 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2480 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2481 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2482 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2483 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2484 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2485 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2486 @code{address_operand}.
2487 @end defmac
2488
2489 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2490 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2491 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2492 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2493 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2494 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2495 than other base register uses.
2496
2497 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2498 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2499 @end defmac
2500
2501 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2502 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2503 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2504 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2505 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2506 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2507 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2508 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2509 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2510 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2511 @end defmac
2512
2513 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2514 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2515 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2516 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2517 allocated such a hard register.
2518
2519 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2520 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2521 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2522 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2523 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2524 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2525 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2526 only if neither labeling works.
2527 @end defmac
2528
2529 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2530 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2531 @end deftypefn
2532
2533 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2534 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2535 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2536 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2537 another, smaller class.
2538
2539 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2540
2541 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2542 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2543 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2544 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2545 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2546
2547 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2548 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2549 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2550 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2551 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2552 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2553 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2554 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2555 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2556 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2557 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2558
2559 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2560 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2561 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2562 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2563 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2564 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2565 @end deftypefn
2566
2567 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2568 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2569 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2570 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2571 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2572 safe:
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2579 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2580 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2581 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2582 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2583
2584 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2585 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2586 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2587 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2588 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2589 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2590 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2591 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2592 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2593 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2594 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2595
2596 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2597 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2598 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2599 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2600 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2601 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2602 @end defmac
2603
2604 @defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2605 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2606 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2607 @var{class}, unchanged.
2608
2609 You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2610 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2611 @end defmac
2612
2613 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2614 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2615 input reloads.
2616
2617 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2618 argument.
2619
2620 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2621 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2622 @end deftypefn
2623
2624 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2625 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2626 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2627 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2628 ordinarily be used.
2629
2630 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2631 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2632
2633 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2634 smaller class.
2635
2636 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2637 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2638 @end defmac
2639
2640 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2641 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2642 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2643 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2644 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2645 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2646 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2647 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2648 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2649 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2650 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2651 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2652 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2653
2654 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2655 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2656 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2657 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2658 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2659 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2660 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2661 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2662 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2663 of the scratch register(s).
2664
2665 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2666
2667 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2668 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2669 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2670 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2671 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2672
2673 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2674 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2675 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2676 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2677 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2678 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2679
2680 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2681 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2682 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2683 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2684 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2685
2686 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2687 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2688 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2689 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2690 single-register-class
2691 @c [later: or memory]
2692 output constraint.
2693
2694 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2695 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2696 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2697 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2698
2699 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2700 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2701 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2702 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2703 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2704 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2705 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2706 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2707
2708
2709 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2710 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2711 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2712 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2713
2714 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2715 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2716 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2717
2718 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2719 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2720 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2721 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2722 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2723 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2724 @end deftypefn
2725
2726 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2727 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2728 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2729 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2730 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2731
2732 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2733 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2734 reload phase that it may
2735 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2736 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2737 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2738 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2739 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2740 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2741
2742 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2743 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2744 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2745 class required. If the
2746 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2747 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2748 macros identically.
2749
2750 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2751 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2752 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2753 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2754 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2755
2756 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2757 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2758 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2759 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2760 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2761 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2762 register.
2763
2764 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2765 register that
2766 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2767 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2768 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2769 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2770 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2771
2772 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2773 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2774 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2775 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2776
2777 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2778 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2779 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2780 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2781 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2782 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2783 general registers.
2784 @end defmac
2785
2786 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2787 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2788 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2789 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2790 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2791 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2792 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2793
2794 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2795 @end defmac
2796
2797 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2798 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2799 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2800 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2801 defined by this macro.
2802
2803 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2804 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2805 @end defmac
2806
2807 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2808 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2809 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2810 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2811 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2812 same as that of @var{mode}.
2813
2814 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2815 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2816 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2817 registers.
2818
2819 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2820 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2821 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2822 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2823 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2824 details.
2825
2826 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2827 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2828 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2829 @end defmac
2830
2831 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2832 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2833 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2834 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2835
2836 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2837 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2838 default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2839 if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2840 hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2841 @code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2842 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2843 register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2844 you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2845 the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2846 allocation.
2847 @end deftypefn
2848
2849 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
2850 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2851 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2852
2853 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2854 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2855 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2856 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2857 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2858
2859 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2860 in the reload pass.
2861
2862 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2863 in words.
2864 @end deftypefn
2865
2866 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2867 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2868 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2869
2870 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2871 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2872 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2873 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2874
2875 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2876 in the reload pass.
2877 @end defmac
2878
2879 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2880 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2881 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2882
2883 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2884 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2885 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2886 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2887 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2888 as below:
2889
2890 @smallexample
2891 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2892 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2893 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2894 @end smallexample
2895 @end defmac
2896
2897 @node Old Constraints
2898 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2899 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2900 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2901
2902 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2903 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2904 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2905 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2906
2907 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2908 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2909 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2910 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2911 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2912 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2913 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2914 to handle specially.
2915 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2916 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2917 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2918 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2919 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2920 @end defmac
2921
2922 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2923 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2924 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2925 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2926 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2927 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2928 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2929 @end defmac
2930
2931 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2932 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2933 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2934 different variants.
2935 @end defmac
2936
2937 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2938 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2939 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2940 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2941 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2942 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2943 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2944 @var{value}.
2945 @end defmac
2946
2947 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2948 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2949 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2950 between different variants.
2951 @end defmac
2952
2953 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2954 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2955 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2956 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2957
2958 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2959 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2960 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2961 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2962
2963 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2964 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2965 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2966 between these kinds.
2967 @end defmac
2968
2969 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2970 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2971 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2972 between different variants.
2973 @end defmac
2974
2975 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2976 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2977 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2978 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2979 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2980 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2981 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2982
2983 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2984 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2985 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2986 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2987
2988 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2989 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2990 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2991 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2992 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2993 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2994 does not include r0 on the output.
2995 @end defmac
2996
2997 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2998 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2999 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3000 variants.
3001 @end defmac
3002
3003 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3004 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3005 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3006 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3007
3008 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3009 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3010 comprises a subset of all memory references including
3011 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3012 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3013 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3014
3015 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3016 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3017 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3018 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3019 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3020 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3021 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3022 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3023 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3024 @end defmac
3025
3026 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3027 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3028 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3029 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3030 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3031
3032 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3033 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3034 a subset of all memory addresses including
3035 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3036 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3037 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3038
3039 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3040 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3041 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3042 @end defmac
3043
3044 @node Stack and Calling
3045 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3046 @cindex calling conventions
3047
3048 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3049 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3050
3051 @menu
3052 * Frame Layout::
3053 * Exception Handling::
3054 * Stack Checking::
3055 * Frame Registers::
3056 * Elimination::
3057 * Stack Arguments::
3058 * Register Arguments::
3059 * Scalar Return::
3060 * Aggregate Return::
3061 * Caller Saves::
3062 * Function Entry::
3063 * Profiling::
3064 * Tail Calls::
3065 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3066 @end menu
3067
3068 @node Frame Layout
3069 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3070 @cindex stack frame layout
3071 @cindex frame layout
3072
3073 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3074 Here is the basic stack layout.
3075
3076 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3077 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3078 pointer to a smaller address.
3079
3080 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3081 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3082 definition used does not matter.
3083 @end defmac
3084
3085 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3086 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3087 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3088 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3089
3090 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3091 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3092 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3093 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3094 space for the next item on the stack.
3095
3096 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3097 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3098 which is often wrong.
3099 @end defmac
3100
3101 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3102 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3103 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3104 @end defmac
3105
3106 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3107 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3108 addresses on the stack.
3109 @end defmac
3110
3111 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3112 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3113
3114 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3115 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3116 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3117 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3118 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3119 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3120 @end defmac
3121
3122 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3123 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3124 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3125
3126 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3127 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3128 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3129 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3130 @end defmac
3131
3132 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3133 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3134 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3135 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3136
3137 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3138 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3139 @end defmac
3140
3141 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3142 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3143 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3144 function.
3145
3146 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3147 the first argument's address.
3148 @end defmac
3149
3150 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3151 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3152 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3153
3154 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3155 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3156 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3157 @end defmac
3158
3159 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3160 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3161 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3162 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3163 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3164 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3165 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3166 @end defmac
3167
3168 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3169 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3170 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3171 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3172 itself.
3173
3174 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3175 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3176 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3177 @end defmac
3178
3179 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3180 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3181 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3182 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3183 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3184 define this macro.
3185 @end defmac
3186
3187 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3188 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3189 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3190 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3191 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3192 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3193 @end deftypefn
3194
3195 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3196 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3197 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3198 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3199 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3200 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3201 @end defmac
3202
3203 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3204 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3205 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3206 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3207 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3208 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3209
3210 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3211 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3212 determine the return address of other frames.
3213 @end defmac
3214
3215 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3216 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3217 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3218 @end defmac
3219
3220 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3221 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3222 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3223 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3224 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3225 the stack.
3226
3227 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3228 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3229
3230 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3231 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3232 @end defmac
3233
3234 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3235 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3236 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3237 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3238 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3239
3240 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3241 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3242 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3243 over time.
3244 @end defmac
3245
3246 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3247 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3248 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3249 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3250 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3251 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3252 @end defmac
3253
3254 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3255 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3256 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3257 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3258 @smallexample
3259 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3260 @end smallexample
3261 and
3262 @smallexample
3263 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3264 @end smallexample
3265 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3266 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3267 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3268 @end deftypefn
3269
3270 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3271 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3272 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3273 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3274 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3275 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3276
3277 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3278 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3279 @end defmac
3280
3281 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3282 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3283 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3284 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3285 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3286 during virtual register instantiation.
3287
3288 The default value for this macro is
3289 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3290 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3291 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3292 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3293 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3294
3295 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3296 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3297 DWARF 2.
3298 @end defmac
3299
3300 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3301 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3302 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3303 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3304 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3305
3306 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3307 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3308 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3309 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3310 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3311 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3312 should be defined.
3313 @end defmac
3314
3315 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3316 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3317 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3318 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3319 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3320 @end defmac
3321
3322 @node Exception Handling
3323 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3324 @cindex exception handling
3325
3326 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3327 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3328 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3329 @var{N} registers are usable.
3330
3331 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3332 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3333 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3334 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3335 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3336
3337 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3338 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3339 @end defmac
3340
3341 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3342 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3343 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3344 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3345 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3346
3347 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3348 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3349
3350 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3351 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3352 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3353 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3354 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3355 that provided by DWARF 2.
3356 @end defmac
3357
3358 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3359 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3360 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3361 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3362
3363 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3364 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3365 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3366 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3367 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3368 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3369 target call frame.
3370
3371 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3372 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3373 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3374
3375 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3376 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3377 @end defmac
3378
3379 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3380 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3381 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3382 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3383 using it to return to the exception handler.
3384 @end defmac
3385
3386 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3387 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3388 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3389 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3390 and so may be read-only.
3391
3392 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3393 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3394 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3395 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3396
3397 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3398 represented directly.
3399 @end defmac
3400
3401 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3402 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3403 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3404 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3405 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3406
3407 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3408 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3409 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3410 to be emitted.
3411 @end defmac
3412
3413 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3414 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3415 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3416 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3417 through signal frames.
3418
3419 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3420 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3421 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3422 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3423 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3424 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3425 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3426 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3427 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3428
3429 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3430 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3431 @end defmac
3432
3433 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3434 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3435 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3436 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3437
3438 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3439 @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3440 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3441 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3442 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3443 be updated in @var{fs}.
3444 @end defmac
3445
3446 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3447 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3448 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3449 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3450 @end defmac
3451
3452 @node Stack Checking
3453 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3454
3455 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3456 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3457 three ways:
3458
3459 @enumerate
3460 @item
3461 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3462 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3463 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3464 other special processing.
3465
3466 @item
3467 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3468 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3469 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3470 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3471 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3472 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3473 approach below.
3474
3475 @item
3476 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3477 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3478 @end enumerate
3479
3480 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3481 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3482 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3483 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3484
3485 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3486 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3487 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3488 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3489 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3490 value of this macro is zero.
3491 @end defmac
3492
3493 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3494 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3495 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3496 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3497 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3498 @end defmac
3499
3500 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3501 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3502 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3503 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3504 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3505 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3506 @end defmac
3507
3508 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3509 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3510 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3511 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3512 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3513 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3514 default value of this macro is zero.
3515 @end defmac
3516
3517 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3518 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3519 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3520 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3521 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3522 most machines.
3523 @end defmac
3524
3525 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3526 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3527 in the opposite case.
3528
3529 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3530 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3531 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3532 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3533 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3534 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3535 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3536 @end defmac
3537
3538 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3539 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3540 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3541 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3542 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3543 use the default of four words.
3544 @end defmac
3545
3546 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3547 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3548 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3549 @option{-fstack-check}.
3550 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3551 normally not need to override that default.
3552 @end defmac
3553
3554 @need 2000
3555 @node Frame Registers
3556 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3557
3558 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3559 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3560
3561 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3562 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3563 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3564 the hardware determines which register this is.
3565 @end defmac
3566
3567 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3568 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3569 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3570 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3571 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3572 @end defmac
3573
3574 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3575 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3576 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3577 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3578 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3579 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3580 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3581 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3582 used for the frame pointer.
3583
3584 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3585 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3586 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3587 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3588 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3589 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3590 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3591
3592 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3593 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3594 @end defmac
3595
3596 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3597 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3598 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3599 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3600 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3601 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3602 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3603 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3604 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3605 @end defmac
3606
3607 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3608 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3609 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3610 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3611 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3612 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3613 @end defmac
3614
3615 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3616 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3617 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3618 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3619 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3620 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3621 @end defmac
3622
3623 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3624 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3625 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3626 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3627 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3628 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3629 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3630
3631 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3632 address from the stack.
3633 @end defmac
3634
3635 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3636 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3637 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3638 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3639 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3640 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3641 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3642 not be defined.
3643
3644 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3645
3646 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3647 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3648 @end defmac
3649
3650 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3651 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3652 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3653 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3654 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3655 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3656
3657 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3658
3659 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3660 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3661 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3662 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3663 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3664 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3665 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3666 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3667 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3668 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3669 to refer to those items.
3670 @end deftypefn
3671
3672 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3673 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3674 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3675 DWARF2 exception handling.
3676
3677 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3678 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3679 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3680 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3681 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3682 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3683 registers that are not call-saved.
3684
3685 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3686 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3687 @end defmac
3688
3689 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3690
3691 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3692 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3693
3694 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3695 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3696 @end defmac
3697
3698 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3699
3700 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3701 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3702 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3703 column number to use instead.
3704
3705 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3706 @end defmac
3707
3708 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3709
3710 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3711 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3712 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3713 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3714 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3715
3716 @end defmac
3717
3718 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3719
3720 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3721 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3722 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3723 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3724 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3725
3726 @end defmac
3727
3728 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3729
3730 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3731 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3732 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3733 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3734
3735 @end defmac
3736
3737 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3738
3739 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3740 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3741 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3742 defined and 0 otherwise.
3743
3744 @end defmac
3745
3746 @node Elimination
3747 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3748
3749 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3750 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3751
3752 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3753 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3754 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3755 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3756
3757 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3758 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3759 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3760 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3761 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3762 pointer.
3763
3764 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3765 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3766 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3767 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3768 them.
3769
3770 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3771 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3772 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3773
3774 Default return value is @code{false}.
3775 @end deftypefn
3776
3777 @findex get_frame_size
3778 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3779 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3780 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3781 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3782 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3783 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3784
3785 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3786 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3787 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3788 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3789 @end defmac
3790
3791 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3792 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3793 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3794 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3795 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3796
3797 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3798 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3799
3800 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3801 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3802 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3803 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3804 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3805
3806 In this case, you might specify:
3807 @smallexample
3808 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3809 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3810 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3811 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3812 @end smallexample
3813
3814 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3815 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3816 @end defmac
3817
3818 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3819 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3820 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3821 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3822 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3823 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3824 knows about.
3825
3826 Default return value is @code{true}.
3827 @end deftypefn
3828
3829 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3830 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3831 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3832 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3833 defined.
3834 @end defmac
3835
3836 @node Stack Arguments
3837 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3838 @cindex arguments on stack
3839 @cindex stack arguments
3840
3841 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3842 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3843 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3844
3845 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3846 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3847 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3848 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3849 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3850 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3851 @end deftypefn
3852
3853 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3854 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3855 outgoing arguments.
3856 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3857 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3858 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3859 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3860 @end defmac
3861
3862 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3863 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3864 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3865 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3866 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3867 @end defmac
3868
3869 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3870 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3871 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3872
3873 On some machines, the definition
3874
3875 @smallexample
3876 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3877 @end smallexample
3878
3879 @noindent
3880 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3881 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3882 alignment. Then the definition should be
3883
3884 @smallexample
3885 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3886 @end smallexample
3887
3888 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3889 @end defmac
3890
3891 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3892 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3893 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3894 will be computed and placed into the variable
3895 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3896 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3897 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3898
3899 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3900 is not proper.
3901 @end defmac
3902
3903 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3904 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3905 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3906 registers.
3907
3908 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3909 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3910 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3911 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3912 of the function.
3913
3914 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3915 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3916 which.
3917 @end defmac
3918 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3919 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3920
3921 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3922 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3923 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3924 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3925 if the function called is a library function.
3926
3927 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3928 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3929 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3930 @end defmac
3931
3932 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3933 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3934 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3935 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3936 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3937
3938 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3939 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3940 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3941 stack in its natural location.
3942 @end defmac
3943
3944 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3945 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3946 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3947 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3948
3949 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3950 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3951 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3952 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3953
3954 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3955 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3956 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3957 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3958 arguments (if known).
3959
3960 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3961 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3962 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3963 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3964 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3965 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3966
3967 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3968 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3969 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3970
3971 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3972 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3973 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3974 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3975 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3976 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3977 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3978 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3979 number of arguments.
3980 @end deftypefn
3981
3982 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3983 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3984 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3985 when compiling a function call.
3986
3987 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3988 have been accumulated.
3989
3990 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3991 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3992 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3993 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3994 appropriate.
3995 @end defmac
3996
3997 @node Register Arguments
3998 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3999 @cindex arguments in registers
4000 @cindex registers arguments
4001
4002 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4003 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4004 the stack.
4005
4006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4007 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
4008 register and if so, which register.
4009
4010 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
4011 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4012 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4013 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4014 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
4015 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
4016 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
4017 syntax error has previously occurred.
4018
4019 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4020 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
4021 on the stack.
4022
4023 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4024 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4025 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4026 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4027 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4028 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4029 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4030 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4031 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4032 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4033 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4034 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4035 argument is also stored on the stack.
4036
4037 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4038 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4039 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4040
4041 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4042 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4043 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4044 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4045 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4046 @var{named} is @code{false}.
4047
4048 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4049 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4050 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4051 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4052 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4053 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4054 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4055 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4056 a register.
4057 @end deftypefn
4058
4059 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4060 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4061 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4062 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4063 documentation.
4064 @end deftypefn
4065
4066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4067 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4068 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4069 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4070 argument.
4071
4072 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4073 which the caller passes the value, and
4074 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4075 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4076 arrive.
4077
4078 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4079 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4080 @end deftypefn
4081
4082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4083 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4084 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4085 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4086 pushed on the stack.
4087
4088 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4089 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4090 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4091 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4092 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4093 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4094 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4095
4096 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4097 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4098 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4099 @end deftypefn
4100
4101 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4102 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4103 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4104 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4105 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4106
4107 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4108 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4109 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4110 to that type.
4111 @end deftypefn
4112
4113 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4114 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4115 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4116 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4117 by the caller.
4118
4119 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4120 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4121 not be generated.
4122
4123 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4124 @end deftypefn
4125
4126 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4127 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4128 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4129 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4130 of bytes of argument so far.
4131
4132 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4133 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4134 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4135 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4136 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4137 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4138 @end defmac
4139
4140 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4141 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4142 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4143 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4144 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4145 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4146 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4147 @end defmac
4148
4149 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4150 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4151 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4152 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4153 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4154 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4155 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4156 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4157 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4158 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4159 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4160 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4161 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4162
4163 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4164 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4165 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4166 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4167 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4168 never both of them at once.
4169 @end defmac
4170
4171 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4172 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4173 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4174 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4175 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4176 0)} is used instead.
4177 @end defmac
4178
4179 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4180 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4181 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4182 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4183
4184 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4185 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4186 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4187 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4188 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4189 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4190 @end defmac
4191
4192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4193 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4194 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4195 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4196 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4197 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4198
4199 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4200 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4201 used for arguments without any special help.
4202 @end deftypefn
4203
4204 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4205 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4206 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4207 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4208 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4209 top.
4210 @end defmac
4211
4212 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4213 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4214 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4215 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4216 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4217
4218 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4219 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4220 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4221
4222 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4223 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4224 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4225 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4226 @end defmac
4227
4228 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4229 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4230 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4231 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4232 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4233 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4234 @end defmac
4235
4236 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4237 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4238 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4239 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4240 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4241 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4242 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4243 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4244 required.
4245 @end defmac
4246
4247 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4248 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4249 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4250 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4251 @end deftypefn
4252
4253 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4254 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4255 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4256 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4257 value.
4258 @end deftypefn
4259
4260 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4261 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4262 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4263 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4264 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4265 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4266 stack.
4267 @end defmac
4268
4269 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4270 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4271 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4272 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4273 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4274 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4275 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4276 point register.
4277
4278 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4279 false.
4280 @end deftypefn
4281
4282 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4283 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4284 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4285 @end deftypefn
4286
4287 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4288 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4289 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4290 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4291 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4292 variable.
4293 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4294 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4295 internal type.
4296 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4297 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4298 macro to iterate through all types.
4299 @end deftypefn
4300
4301 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4302 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4303 @var{fndecl}.
4304 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4305 @end deftypefn
4306
4307 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4308 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4309 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4310 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4311 @end deftypefn
4312
4313 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4314 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4315 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4316 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4317 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4318 @end deftypefn
4319
4320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4321 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4322 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4323 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4324 @end deftypefn
4325
4326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref_s *@var{ref})
4327 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4328 @end deftypefn
4329
4330 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4331 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4332 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4333 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4334 must work.
4335
4336 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4337 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4338 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4339 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4340 @end deftypefn
4341
4342 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4343 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4344 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4345 must have move patterns for this mode.
4346 @end deftypefn
4347
4348 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4349 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4350 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4351 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4352 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4353
4354 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4355 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4356 has operations like:
4357
4358 @smallexample
4359 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4360 @end smallexample
4361
4362 where the return type is defined as:
4363
4364 @smallexample
4365 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4366 @{
4367 int8x8_t val[3];
4368 @} int8x8x3_t;
4369 @end smallexample
4370
4371 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4372 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4373 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4374 @end deftypefn
4375
4376 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4377 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4378 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4379 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4380 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4381 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4382 for any mode.
4383
4384 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4385 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4386 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4387 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4388 insn.
4389
4390 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4391 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4392 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4393 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4394 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4395 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4396 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4397 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4398 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4399
4400 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4401 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4402 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4403 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4404 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4405 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4406 @end deftypefn
4407
4408 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4409 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
4410 @end deftypevr
4411
4412 @node Scalar Return
4413 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4414 @cindex return values in registers
4415 @cindex values, returned by functions
4416 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4417
4418 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4419 values---values that can fit in registers.
4420
4421 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4422
4423 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4424 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4425 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4426 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4427 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4428 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4429 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4430 a function returns a value.
4431
4432 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4433 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4434 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4435 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4436 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4437 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4438 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4439 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4440 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4441 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4442 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4443 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4444
4445 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4446 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4447 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4448
4449 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4450 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4451 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4452 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4453 known.
4454
4455 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4456 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4457 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4458 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4459
4460 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4461 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4462 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4463 @end deftypefn
4464
4465 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4466 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4467 a new target instead.
4468 @end defmac
4469
4470 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4471 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4472 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4473
4474 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4475 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4476 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4477 compiled.
4478 @end defmac
4479
4480 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4481 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4482 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4483
4484 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4485 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4486 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4487
4488 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4489 @end deftypefn
4490
4491 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4492 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4493 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4494
4495 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4496 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4497 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4498 suffices:
4499
4500 @smallexample
4501 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4502 @end smallexample
4503
4504 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4505 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4506 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4507
4508 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4509 for a new target instead.
4510 @end defmac
4511
4512 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4513 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4514 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4515
4516 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4517 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4518 recognized by this target hook.
4519
4520 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4521 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4522 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4523
4524 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4525 @end deftypefn
4526
4527 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4528 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4529 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4530 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4531 @end defmac
4532
4533 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4534 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4535 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4536 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4537 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4538
4539 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4540 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4541 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4542 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4543 @code{SImode} rtx.
4544 @end deftypefn
4545
4546 @node Aggregate Return
4547 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4548 @cindex aggregates as return values
4549 @cindex large return values
4550 @cindex returning aggregate values
4551 @cindex structure value address
4552
4553 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4554 cases), the value is not returned according to
4555 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4556 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4557 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4558 address}.
4559
4560 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4561 memory.
4562
4563 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4564 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4565 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4566 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4567 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4568 libcalls.
4569
4570 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4571 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4572 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4573 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4574 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4575 values, and 0 otherwise.
4576
4577 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4578 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4579 to indicate this.
4580 @end deftypefn
4581
4582 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4583 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4584 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4585 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4586 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4587 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4588 target hook.
4589
4590 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4591 @end defmac
4592
4593 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4594 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4595 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4596 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4597 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4598 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4599 argument.
4600
4601 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4602 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4603 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4604 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4605 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4606 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4607 the caller.
4608
4609 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4610 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4611 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4612 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4613 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4614 @end deftypefn
4615
4616 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4617 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4618 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4619 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4620
4621 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4622 pass an address to the subroutine.
4623
4624 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4625 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4626 @end defmac
4627
4628 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4629 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4630 @end deftypefn
4631
4632 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4633 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4634 @end deftypefn
4635
4636 @node Caller Saves
4637 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4638
4639 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4640 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4641 must live across calls.
4642
4643 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4644 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4645 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4646 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4647 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4648
4649 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4650 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4651 @end defmac
4652
4653 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4654 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4655 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4656 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4657 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4658 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4659 @end defmac
4660
4661 @node Function Entry
4662 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4663 @cindex function entry and exit
4664 @cindex prologue
4665 @cindex epilogue
4666
4667 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4668 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4669
4670 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4671 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4672 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4673 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4674 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4675 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4676 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4677
4678 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4679 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4680
4681 @findex regs_ever_live
4682 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4683 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4684 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4685 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4686 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4687 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4688
4689 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4690 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4691 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4692 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4693 registers are used in the function.
4694
4695 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4696 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4697 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4698 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4699 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4700 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4701 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4702
4703 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4704 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4705 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4706 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4707 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4708 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4709 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4710 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4711 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4712 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4713 @end deftypefn
4714
4715 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4716 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4717 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4718 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4719 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4720 @end deftypefn
4721
4722 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4723 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4724 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4725 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4726 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4727 @end deftypefn
4728
4729 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4730 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4731 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4732 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4733 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4734 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4735 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4736 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4737
4738 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4739 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4740 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4741 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4742
4743 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4744 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4745 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4746 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4747 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4748 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4749
4750 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4751 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4752 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4753 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4754 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4755 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4756
4757 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4758 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4759 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4760 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4761
4762 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4763 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4764 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4765 number of arguments.
4766
4767 @findex current_function_pops_args
4768 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4769 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4770 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4771 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4772 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4773 @end deftypefn
4774
4775 @itemize @bullet
4776 @item
4777 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4778 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4779 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4780 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4781 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4782 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4783 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4784 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4785 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4786 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4787
4788 @item
4789 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4790 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4791 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4792 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4793 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4794 a save area.
4795
4796 @item
4797 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4798 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4799 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4800 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4801
4802 @item
4803 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4804 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4805 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4806 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4807 @end itemize
4808
4809 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4810 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4811 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4812 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4813 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4814 default is 0.
4815
4816 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4817 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4818 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4819 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4820 @end defmac
4821
4822 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4823 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4824 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4825 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4826 @end defmac
4827
4828 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4829 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4830 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4831 on entry to an exception edge.
4832 @end defmac
4833
4834 @defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4835 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4836 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4837 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4838 representing the number of delay slots there.
4839 @end defmac
4840
4841 @defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4842 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4843 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4844
4845 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4846 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4847 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4848 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4849 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4850 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4851 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4852 slot.
4853
4854 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4855 @findex final_scan_insn
4856 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4857 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4858 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4859 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4860 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4861 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4862 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4863
4864 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4865 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4866 @end defmac
4867
4868 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4869 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4870 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4871 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4872 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4873 the real function.
4874
4875 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4876 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4877 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4878 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4879 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4880 all other incoming arguments.
4881
4882 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4883 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4884 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4885
4886 @smallexample
4887 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4888 @end smallexample
4889
4890 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4891 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4892 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4893 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4894
4895 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4896 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4897 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4898 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4899
4900 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4901 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4902 some targets, but probably not.
4903
4904 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4905 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4906 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4907 not support varargs.
4908 @end deftypefn
4909
4910 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4911 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4912 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4913 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4914 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4915 previously exposed.
4916 @end deftypefn
4917
4918 @node Profiling
4919 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4920 @cindex profiling, code generation
4921
4922 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4923
4924 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4925 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4926 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4927
4928 @findex mcount
4929 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4930 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4931 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4932 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4933
4934 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4935 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4936 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4937 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4938 @end defmac
4939
4940 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4941 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4942 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4943 not support profiling.
4944 @end defmac
4945
4946 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4947 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4948 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4949 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4950 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4951 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4952 @end defmac
4953
4954 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4955 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4956 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4957 @end defmac
4958
4959 @node Tail Calls
4960 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4961 @cindex tail calls
4962
4963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4964 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4965 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4966 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4967
4968 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4969 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4970 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4971 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4972 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4973 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4974 @end deftypefn
4975
4976 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4977 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4978 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4979 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4980 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4981 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4982 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4983 @end deftypefn
4984
4985 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4986 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4987 @cindex stack smashing protection
4988
4989 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4990 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4991 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4992 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4993 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4994 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4995
4996 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4997 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4998 @end deftypefn
4999
5000 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
5001 This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
5002 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
5003 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5004
5005 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
5006 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
5007 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5008 @end deftypefn
5009
5010 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
5011 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5012 @end deftypefn
5013
5014 @node Varargs
5015 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5016 @cindex varargs implementation
5017
5018 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5019 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5020 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5021 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5022 conditionals to include it.
5023
5024 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5025 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5026 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5027 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5028 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5029 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5030
5031 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5032 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5033 below.
5034
5035 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5036 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5037 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5038 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5039 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5040
5041 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5042 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5043 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5044 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5045
5046 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5047 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5048 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5049 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5050 to use them for its own purposes.
5051 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5052 @c 10feb93
5053 @end defmac
5054
5055 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5056 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5057 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5058 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5059 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5060 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5061 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5062 of the current function.
5063 @end defmac
5064
5065 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5066 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5067 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5068 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5069 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5070 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5071
5072 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5073 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5074 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5075
5076 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5077 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5078 @end defmac
5079
5080 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5081
5082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5083 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5084 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5085 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5086 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5087 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5088 @end deftypefn
5089
5090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5091 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5092 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5093 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5094 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5095 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5096 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5097 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5098
5099 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5100 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5101 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5102 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5103
5104 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5105 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5106 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5107 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5108 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5109 frame.
5110
5111 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5112 compile time without knowing their data types,
5113 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5114 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5115 for all data types.
5116
5117 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5118 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5119 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5120 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5121 not generate any instructions in this case.
5122 @end deftypefn
5123
5124 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5125 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5126 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5127
5128 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5129 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5130 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5131 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5132 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5133 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5134 except the last are treated as named.
5135
5136 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5137 @end deftypefn
5138
5139 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5140 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5141 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5142 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5143 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5144 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5145 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5146 @end deftypefn
5147
5148 @node Trampolines
5149 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5150 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5151 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5152
5153 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5154 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5155 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5156 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5157 trampoline.
5158
5159 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5160 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5161 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5162 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5163 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5164 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5165 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5166 operands.
5167
5168 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5169 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5170 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5171 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5172 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5173 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5174 separately.
5175
5176 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5177 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5178 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5179 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5180 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5181
5182 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5183 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5184 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5185 to generate it on the spot.
5186 @end deftypefn
5187
5188 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5189 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5190 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5191 @end defmac
5192
5193 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5194 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5195 @end defmac
5196
5197 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5198 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5199
5200 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5201 is used for aligning trampolines.
5202 @end defmac
5203
5204 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5205 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5206 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5207 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5208 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5209 when it is called.
5210
5211 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5212 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5213 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5214 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5215 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5216 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5217
5218 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5219 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5220 initializing the trampoline proper.
5221 @end deftypefn
5222
5223 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5224 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5225 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5226 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5227 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5228 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5229 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5230 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5231 @end deftypefn
5232
5233 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5234 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5235 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5236 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5237
5238 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5239 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5240 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5241 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5242 latter makes initialization faster.
5243
5244 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5245 the following macro.
5246
5247 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5248 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5249 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5250 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5251 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5252 @end defmac
5253
5254 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5255 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5256 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5257 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5258 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5259
5260 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5261 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5262 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5263 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5264 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5265
5266 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5267 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5268 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5269 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5270 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5271 special assembler code.
5272 @end defmac
5273
5274 @node Library Calls
5275 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5276 @cindex library subroutine names
5277 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5278
5279 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5280 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5281
5282 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5283 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5284 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5285 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5286 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5287 @end defmac
5288
5289 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5290 @findex init_one_libfunc
5291 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5292 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5293 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5294 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5295 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5296 library routines.
5297
5298 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5299 @end deftypefn
5300
5301 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5302 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5303 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5304 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5305 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5306 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5307 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5308 @end deftypevr
5309
5310 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5311 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5312 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5313 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5314 return a tristate.
5315
5316 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5317 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5318 don't need to define this macro.
5319 @end defmac
5320
5321 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5322 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5323 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5324 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5325 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5326 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5327 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5328 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5329 @end defmac
5330
5331 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5332 @findex matherr
5333 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5334 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5335 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5336 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5337 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5338 system.
5339
5340 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5341 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5342 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5343 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5344 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5345 @end defmac
5346
5347 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5348 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5349 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5350 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5351 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5352 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5353 @end defmac
5354
5355 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5356 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5357 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5358 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5359 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5360 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5361 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5362 @end defmac
5363
5364 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5365 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5366 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5367 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5368 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5369 @smallexample
5370 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5371 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5372 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5373 @end smallexample
5374 @end defmac
5375
5376 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5377 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5378 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5379 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5380 at once to the method-lookup library function.
5381
5382 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5383 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5384 @end defmac
5385
5386 @node Addressing Modes
5387 @section Addressing Modes
5388 @cindex addressing modes
5389
5390 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5391 This is about addressing modes.
5392
5393 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5394 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5395 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5396 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5397 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5398 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5399 @end defmac
5400
5401 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5402 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5403 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5404 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5405 the size of the memory operand.
5406 @end defmac
5407
5408 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5409 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5410 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5411 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5412 @end defmac
5413
5414 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5415 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5416 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5417 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5418 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5419 constant addresses are supported.
5420 @end defmac
5421
5422 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5423 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5424 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5425 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5426 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5427 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5428 @end defmac
5429
5430 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5431 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5432 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5433 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5434 accept.
5435 @end defmac
5436
5437 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5438 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5439 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5440
5441 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5442 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5443 desired by the caller.
5444
5445 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5446 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5447 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5448 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5449 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5450 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5451 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5452 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5453
5454 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5455 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5456 register is required.
5457
5458 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5459 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5460 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5461 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5462 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5463
5464 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5465 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5466 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5467 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5468 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5469
5470 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5471 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5472 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5473 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5474 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5475 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5476 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5477 Format}.
5478
5479 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5480 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5481 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5482 has this syntax:
5483
5484 @example
5485 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5486 @end example
5487
5488 @noindent
5489 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5490 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5491
5492 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5493 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5494 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5495 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5496 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5497
5498 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5499 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5500 @end deftypefn
5501
5502 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5503 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5504 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5505 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5506 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5507 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5508 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5509 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5510 @code{'m'} constraint.
5511 @end defmac
5512
5513 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5514 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5515 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5516 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5517 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5518
5519 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5520 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5521
5522 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5523 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5524 @end defmac
5525
5526 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5527 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5528 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5529 address.
5530
5531 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5532 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5533 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5534 @var{x}.
5535
5536 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5537 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5538 should return the new @var{x}.
5539
5540 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5541 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5542 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5543 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5544 strategy can generate better code.
5545 @end deftypefn
5546
5547 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5548 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5549 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5550 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5551 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5552 performance reasons.
5553
5554 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5555 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5556 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5557 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5558 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5559 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5560 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5561 be shared.
5562
5563 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5564 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5565 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5566 of reload internals.
5567
5568 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5569 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5570 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5571
5572 @findex push_reload
5573 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5574 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5575 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5576
5577 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5578 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5579 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5580 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5581 @code{push_reload}.
5582
5583 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5584 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5585 the address has become legitimate.
5586
5587 @findex copy_rtx
5588 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5589 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5590 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5591 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5592 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5593 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5594 @end defmac
5595
5596 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr})
5597 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5598 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5599 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5600 but not others.
5601
5602 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5603 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5604 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5605 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5606
5607 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5608
5609 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5610 @end deftypefn
5611
5612 @defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5613 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5614 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5615 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5616 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5617 but not others.
5618
5619 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5620 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5621 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5622 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5623
5624 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5625
5626 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5627 @code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5628 @end defmac
5629
5630 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5631 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5632 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5633 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5634
5635 The default definition returns true.
5636 @end deftypefn
5637
5638 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5639 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5640 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5641 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5642 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5643 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5644 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5645 into their original form.
5646 @end deftypefn
5647
5648 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5649 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5650 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5651 of @var{x}.
5652
5653 The default version of this hook returns false.
5654
5655 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5656 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5657 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5658 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5659 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5660 @end deftypefn
5661
5662 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5663 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5664 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5665 of @var{x}.
5666
5667 The default version returns false for all constants.
5668 @end deftypefn
5669
5670 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5671 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5672 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5673 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5674 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5675 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5676 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5677 function are valid.
5678 @end deftypefn
5679
5680 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5681 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5682 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5683 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5684 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5685
5686 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5687 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5688 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5689 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5690 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5691 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5692 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5693 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5694 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5695 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5696 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5697
5698 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5699 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5700 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5701 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5702 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5703 described above.
5704 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5705 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5706 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5707 @end deftypefn
5708
5709 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN (tree @var{x})
5710 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5711 widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5712
5713 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5714 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5715 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5716 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5717 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5718 @end deftypefn
5719
5720 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD (tree @var{x})
5721 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5722 widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5723
5724 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5725 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5726 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5727 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5728 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5729 @end deftypefn
5730
5731 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5732 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5733 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5734 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5735 @end deftypefn
5736
5737 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5738 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5739 @end deftypefn
5740
5741 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{mask_element_type})
5742 Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5743 @end deftypefn
5744
5745 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK (tree @var{vec_type}, tree @var{mask})
5746 Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5747 @end deftypefn
5748
5749 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5750 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5751 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5752 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5753 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5754 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5755
5756 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5757 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5758 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5759 @end deftypefn
5760
5761 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5762 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5763 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5764 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5765 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5766 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5767 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5768 @end deftypefn
5769
5770 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5771 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5772 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5773 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5774 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5775 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5776 @end deftypefn
5777
5778 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5779 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5780 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5781 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5782 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5783 @end deftypefn
5784
5785 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5786 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5787 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5788 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5789 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5790 @end deftypefn
5791
5792 @node Anchored Addresses
5793 @section Anchored Addresses
5794 @cindex anchored addresses
5795 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5796
5797 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5798 For example, if we have:
5799
5800 @smallexample
5801 static int a, b, c;
5802 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5803 @end smallexample
5804
5805 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5806 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5807 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5808 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5809 be something like:
5810
5811 @smallexample
5812 int foo (void)
5813 @{
5814 register int *xr = &x;
5815 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5816 @}
5817 @end smallexample
5818
5819 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5820 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5821
5822 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5823 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5824 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5825 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5826
5827 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5828 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5829 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5830 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5831 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5832 @end deftypevr
5833
5834 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5835 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5836 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5837 value is 0.
5838 @end deftypevr
5839
5840 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5841 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5842 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5843 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5844 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5845
5846 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5847 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5848 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5849 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5850 @end deftypefn
5851
5852 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5853 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5854 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5855 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5856
5857 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5858 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5859 or target-specific sections.
5860 @end deftypefn
5861
5862 @node Condition Code
5863 @section Condition Code Status
5864 @cindex condition code status
5865
5866 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5867 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5868
5869 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5870 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5871 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5872 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5873 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5874 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5875 most RISC machines.
5876
5877 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5878 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5879 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5880 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5881 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5882 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5883 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5884 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5885
5886 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5887 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5888 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5889 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5890 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5891 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5892 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5893
5894 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5895 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5896 interested in most macros in this section.
5897
5898 @menu
5899 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5900 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5901 * Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5902 @end menu
5903
5904 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5905 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5906 @findex cc0
5907
5908 @findex cc_status
5909 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5910 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5911 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5912 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5913 currently based, and several standard flags.
5914
5915 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5916 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5917 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5918
5919 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5920 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5921 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5922
5923 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5924 @end defmac
5925
5926 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5927 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5928 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5929 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5930 define this macro to initialize it.
5931
5932 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5933 @end defmac
5934
5935 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5936 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5937 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5938 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5939 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5940 set @code{(cc0)}.
5941
5942 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5943
5944 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5945 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5946 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5947 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5948 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5949 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5950 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5951 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5952 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5953 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5954 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5955 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5956 condition code value.
5957
5958 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5959 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5960 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5961 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5962 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5963 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5964 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5965
5966 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5967 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5968 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5969 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5970 @end defmac
5971
5972 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5973 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5974 @findex CCmode
5975 @findex MODE_CC
5976
5977 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5978 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5979 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5980 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5981 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5982 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5983 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5984 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5985 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5986 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5987 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5988
5989 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5990 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5991 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5992 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5993 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5994 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5995 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5996
5997 @smallexample
5998 (define_insn ""
5999 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
6000 (compare:CC_NOOV
6001 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6002 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6003 (const_int 0)))]
6004 ""
6005 "@dots{}")
6006 @end smallexample
6007
6008 @noindent
6009 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6010 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6011
6012 @smallexample
6013 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6014 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6015 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
6016 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6017 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6018 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6019 @end smallexample
6020
6021 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6022 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6023 this section.
6024
6025 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6026 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6027 @end defmac
6028
6029 @defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
6030 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6031 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6032 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6033 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6034
6035 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
6036 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
6037 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
6038 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
6039 @var{op1} as required.
6040
6041 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6042 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6043 @file{md} file.
6044
6045 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6046 code or operands.
6047 @end defmac
6048
6049 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6050 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6051 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6052 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6053 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6054
6055 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6056 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6057 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6058 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6059
6060 @smallexample
6061 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6062 @end smallexample
6063 @end defmac
6064
6065 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6066 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6067 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6068 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6069 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6070 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6071 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6072 like:
6073
6074 @smallexample
6075 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6076 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6077 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6078 @end smallexample
6079 @end defmac
6080
6081 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6082 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6083 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6084 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6085 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6086 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6087 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6088 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6089 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6090 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6091 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6092
6093 The default version of this hook returns false.
6094 @end deftypefn
6095
6096 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
6097 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6098 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6099 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6100 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6101 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6102 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6103
6104 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6105 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6106 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6107 @end deftypefn
6108
6109 @node Cond Exec Macros
6110 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6111 @findex conditional execution
6112 @findex predication
6113
6114 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6115 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6116 represent conditional branches.
6117
6118 @defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6119 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6120 @var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6121 versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6122 predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6123 that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6124 If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6125
6126 @smallexample
6127 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6128 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6129 @end smallexample
6130 @end defmac
6131
6132 @node Costs
6133 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6134 @cindex costs of instructions
6135 @cindex relative costs
6136 @cindex speed of instructions
6137
6138 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6139 on the target machine.
6140
6141 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6142 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6143 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6144 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6145 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6146 that.
6147
6148 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6149 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6150 registers if they are not general registers.
6151
6152 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6153 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6154 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6155 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6156 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6157 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6158
6159 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6160 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6161 @end defmac
6162
6163 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6164 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6165 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6166 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6167 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6168 that.
6169
6170 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6171 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6172 registers if they are not general registers.
6173
6174 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6175 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6176 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6177 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6178 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6179 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6180
6181 The default version of this function returns 2.
6182 @end deftypefn
6183
6184 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6185 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6186 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6187 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6188 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6189 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6190 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6191
6192 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6193 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6194 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6195 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6196 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6197 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6198
6199 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6200 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6201 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6202 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6203 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6204 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6205 are the same as to this macro.
6206
6207 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6208 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6209 @end defmac
6210
6211 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6212 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6213 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6214 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6215 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6216 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6217 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6218
6219 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6220 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6221 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6222 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6223 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6224 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6225
6226 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6227 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6228 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6229 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6230 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6231 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6232 are the same as to this target hook.
6233 @end deftypefn
6234
6235 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6236 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6237 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6238 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6239 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6240 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6241 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6242 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6243 @end defmac
6244
6245 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6246 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6247 ordinarily expect.
6248
6249 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6250 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6251 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6252 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6253 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6254 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6255
6256 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6257 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6258 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6259 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6260 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6261 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6262 @end defmac
6263
6264 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6265 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6266 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6267 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6268 handler.
6269
6270 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6271 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6272 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6273 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6274 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6275
6276 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6277 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6278 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6279 @end defmac
6280
6281 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6282 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6283 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6284 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6285 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6286
6287 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6288 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6289 the number of such sequences.
6290
6291 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6292 optimized for speed rather than size.
6293
6294 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6295 @end defmac
6296
6297 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6298 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6299 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6300 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6301 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6302 @end defmac
6303
6304 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6305 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6306 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6307 @end defmac
6308
6309 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6310 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6311 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6312 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6313 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6314
6315 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6316 optimized for speed rather than size.
6317
6318 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6319 @end defmac
6320
6321 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6322 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6323 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6324 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6325 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6326 @end defmac
6327
6328 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6329 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6330 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6331 a block set insn or a library call.
6332 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6333 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6334
6335 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6336 optimized for speed rather than size.
6337
6338 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6339 @end defmac
6340
6341 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6342 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6343 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6344 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6345 storing values other than constant zero.
6346 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6347 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6348 @end defmac
6349
6350 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6351 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6352 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6353 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6354 called with a constant source string.
6355 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6356 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6357 @end defmac
6358
6359 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6360 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6361 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6362 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6363 @end defmac
6364
6365 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6366 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6367 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6368 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6369 @end defmac
6370
6371 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6372 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6373 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6374 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6375 @end defmac
6376
6377 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6378 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6379 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6380 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6381 @end defmac
6382
6383 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6384 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6385 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6386 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6387 @end defmac
6388
6389 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6390 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6391 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6392 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6393 @end defmac
6394
6395 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6396 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6397 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6398 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6399 @end defmac
6400
6401 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6402 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6403 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6404 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6405 @end defmac
6406
6407 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6408 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6409 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6410 @end defmac
6411
6412 @defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6413 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6414 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6415 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6416 @end defmac
6417
6418 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6419 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6420
6421 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6422 available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6423 in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6424 expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6425 @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6426
6427 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6428 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6429 instructions.
6430
6431 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6432 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6433 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6434 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6435 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6436
6437 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6438 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6439 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6440
6441 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6442 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6443 @end deftypefn
6444
6445 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, bool @var{speed})
6446 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6447 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6448 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6449
6450 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6451 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6452 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6453 all addresses will have equal costs.
6454
6455 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6456 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6457 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6458
6459 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6460 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6461 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6462 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6463 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6464 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6465 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6466 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6467
6468 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6469
6470 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6471 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6472 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6473 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6474 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6475 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6476 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6477 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6478 @end deftypefn
6479
6480 @node Scheduling
6481 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6482
6483 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6484 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6485 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6486 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6487
6488 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6489 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6490 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6491 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6492 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6493 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6494 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6495 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6496 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6497 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6498 @end deftypefn
6499
6500 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6501 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6502 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6503 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6504 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6505 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6506 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6507 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6508 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6509 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6510 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6511 was scheduled.
6512 @end deftypefn
6513
6514 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6515 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6516 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6517 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6518 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6519 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6520 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6521 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6522 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6523 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6524 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6525 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6526 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6527 @end deftypefn
6528
6529 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6530 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6531 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6532 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6533 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6534 scheduling priorities of insns.
6535 @end deftypefn
6536
6537 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6538 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6539 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6540 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6541 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6542 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6543 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6544 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6545 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6546 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6547 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6548 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6549 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6550 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6551 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6552 @end deftypefn
6553
6554 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6555 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6556 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6557 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6558 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6559 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6560 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6561 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6562 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6563 @end deftypefn
6564
6565 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6566 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6567 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6568 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6569 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6570 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6571 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6572 calculated.
6573 @end deftypefn
6574
6575 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6576 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6577 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6578 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6579 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6580 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6581 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6582 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6583 @end deftypefn
6584
6585 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6586 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6587 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6588 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6589 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6590 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6591 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6592 @end deftypefn
6593
6594 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6595 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6596 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6597 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6598 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6599 @end deftypefn
6600
6601 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6602 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6603 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6604 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6605 @end deftypefn
6606
6607 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6608 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6609 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6610 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6611 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6612 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6613 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6614 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6615 @end deftypefn
6616
6617 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6618 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6619 @end deftypefn
6620
6621 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6622 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6623 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6624 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6625 @end deftypefn
6626
6627 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6628 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6629 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6630 @end deftypefn
6631
6632 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6633 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6634 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6635 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6636 state on a single insn is not enough.
6637 @end deftypefn
6638
6639 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6640 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6641 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6642 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6643 state on a single insn is not enough.
6644 @end deftypefn
6645
6646 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6647 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6648 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6649 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6650 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6651 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6652 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6653 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6654 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6655 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6656 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6657
6658 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6659 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6660 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6661 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6662 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6663 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6664 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6665 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6666 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6667
6668 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6669 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6670 schedules to choose the best one.
6671
6672 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6673 @end deftypefn
6674
6675 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
6676
6677 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6678 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6679 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6680 be issued.
6681
6682 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6683 @end deftypefn
6684
6685 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6686 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6687 scheduling.
6688 @end deftypefn
6689
6690 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx @var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6691 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6692 @end deftypefn
6693
6694 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6695 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6696 an instruction.
6697 @end deftypefn
6698
6699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6700 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6701 round of multipass scheduling.
6702 @end deftypefn
6703
6704 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6705 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6706 @end deftypefn
6707
6708 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6709 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6710 @end deftypefn
6711
6712 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6713 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6714 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6715 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6716 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6717 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6718 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6719 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6720 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6721 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6722 and the current processor cycle.
6723 @end deftypefn
6724
6725 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6726 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6727 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6728 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6729 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6730 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6731 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6732 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6733 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6734 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6735 and @code{false} otherwise.
6736
6737 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6738 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6739 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6740 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6741 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6742 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6743 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6744 @end deftypefn
6745
6746 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6747 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6748 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6749 per instruction data structures.
6750 @end deftypefn
6751
6752 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6753 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6754 @end deftypefn
6755
6756 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6757 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6758 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6759 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6760 @end deftypefn
6761
6762 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6763 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6764 @end deftypefn
6765
6766 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6767 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6768 @end deftypefn
6769
6770 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6771 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6772 @end deftypefn
6773
6774 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6775 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6776 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6777 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6778 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6779 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6780 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6781 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6782 the generated speculative pattern.
6783 @end deftypefn
6784
6785 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (int @var{dep_status})
6786 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6787 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6788 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6789 @end deftypefn
6790
6791 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
6792 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6793 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6794 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6795 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6796 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6797 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6798 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6799 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6800 @end deftypefn
6801
6802 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
6803 This hook is used as a workaround for
6804 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6805 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6806 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6807 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6808 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6809 For non-speculative instructions,
6810 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6811 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6812 is nearly full.
6813 @end deftypefn
6814
6815 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6816 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6817 enabled/used.
6818 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6819 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6820 @end deftypefn
6821
6822 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6823 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6824 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6825 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6826 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6827 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6828 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6829 @end deftypefn
6830
6831 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6832 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6833 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6834 @end deftypefn
6835
6836 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6837 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6838 in its second parameter.
6839 @end deftypefn
6840
6841 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6842 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6843 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6844 also the latencies of operations.
6845 @end deftypevr
6846
6847 @node Sections
6848 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6849 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6850 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6851
6852 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6853 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6854 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6855 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6856 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6857 of sections.
6858
6859 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6860 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6861 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6862 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6863 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6864 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6865 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6866
6867 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6868 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6869 to be string literals.
6870
6871 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6872 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6873 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6874 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6875
6876 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6877 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6878 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6879 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6880 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6881 reuse @code{text_section}.
6882
6883 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6884 if the target does not provide them.
6885
6886 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6887 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6888 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6889 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6890 @end defmac
6891
6892 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6893 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6894 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6895 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6896 @end defmac
6897
6898 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6899 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6900 executed functions in the program.
6901 @end defmac
6902
6903 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6904 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6905 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6906 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6907 @end defmac
6908
6909 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6910 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6911 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6912 initialized, writable small data.
6913 @end defmac
6914
6915 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6916 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6917 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6918 data.
6919 @end defmac
6920
6921 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6922 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6923 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6924 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6925 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6926 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6927 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6928 used.
6929 @end defmac
6930
6931 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6932 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6933 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6934 uninitialized, writable small data.
6935 @end defmac
6936
6937 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6938 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6939 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6940 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6941 @end defmac
6942
6943 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6944 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6945 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6946 default is @code{'T'}.
6947 @end defmac
6948
6949 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6950 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6951 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6952 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6953 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6954 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6955 @end defmac
6956
6957 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6958 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6959 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6960 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6961 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6962 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6963 @end defmac
6964
6965 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6966 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6967 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6968 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6969 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6970 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6971 @end defmac
6972
6973 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6974 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6975 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6976 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6977 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6978 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6979 @end defmac
6980
6981 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6982 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6983 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6984 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6985 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6986 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6987 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6988 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6989 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6990 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6991 @end defmac
6992
6993 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6994 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6995 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6996 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6997 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6998 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6999 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7000 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7001 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7002 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7003 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7004 @end defmac
7005
7006 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7007 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7008 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7009 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7010 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7011 @end defmac
7012
7013 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7014 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7015 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7016 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7017 readonly data section is used.
7018
7019 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7020 @end defmac
7021
7022 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7023 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7024 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7025 of its own that you need to create.
7026
7027 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7028 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7029 described below.
7030 @end deftypefn
7031
7032 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7033 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7034 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7035 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7036 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7037
7038 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7039 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7040 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7041 in read-only sections even in executables.
7042 @end deftypefn
7043
7044 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7045 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7046 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7047 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7048 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7049 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7050 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7051
7052 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7053 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7054
7055 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7056 @end deftypefn
7057
7058 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7059 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7060 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7061
7062 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7063 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7064 it is unlikely to be called.
7065 @end defmac
7066
7067 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7068 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7069 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7070 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7071 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7072
7073 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7074 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7075 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7076 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7077 @end deftypefn
7078
7079 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7080 Return the readonly data section associated with
7081 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7082 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7083 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7084 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7085 otherwise.
7086 @end deftypefn
7087
7088 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7089 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7090 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7091 the string if a different section name should be used.
7092 @end deftypevr
7093
7094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7095 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7096 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7097 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7098 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7099 in bits.
7100
7101 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7102 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7103 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7104 @end deftypefn
7105
7106 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7107 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7108 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7109 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7110 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7111 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7112 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7113 returns the @var{id} provided.
7114 @end deftypefn
7115
7116 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7117 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7118 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7119 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7120
7121 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7122 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7123 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7124 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7125 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7126
7127 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7128 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7129 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7130 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7131 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7132 leave it alone.)
7133
7134 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7135 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7136 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7137 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7138 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7139 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7140
7141 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7142 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7143 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7144 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7145 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7146 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7147
7148 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7149 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7150 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7151 before overriding it.
7152 @end deftypefn
7153
7154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7155 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7156 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7157 may have added.
7158 @end deftypefn
7159
7160 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7161 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7162 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7163 @end deftypefn
7164
7165 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7166 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7167 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7168 @end deftypevr
7169
7170 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7171 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7172
7173 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7174 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7175 @end deftypefn
7176
7177 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7178 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7179 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7180 or executable image).
7181
7182 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7183 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7184 currently supported object file formats.
7185 @end deftypefn
7186
7187 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7188 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7189 The default value is false.
7190 @end deftypevr
7191
7192
7193 @node PIC
7194 @section Position Independent Code
7195 @cindex position independent code
7196 @cindex PIC
7197
7198 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7199 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7200 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7201 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7202 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7203 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7204 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7205 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7206 relative addresses.
7207 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7208 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7209
7210 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7211 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7212 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7213 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7214 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7215 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7216 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7217 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7218 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7219 @end defmac
7220
7221 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7222 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7223 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7224 the default is zero. Do not define
7225 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7226 @end defmac
7227
7228 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7229 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7230 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7231 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7232 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7233 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7234 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7235 position independent code.
7236 @end defmac
7237
7238 @node Assembler Format
7239 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7240
7241 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7242 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7243 instructions do.
7244
7245 @menu
7246 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7247 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7248 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7249 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7250 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7251 and termination routines.
7252 * Macros for Initialization::
7253 Specific macros that control the handling of
7254 initialization and termination routines.
7255 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7256 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7257 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7258 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7259 @end menu
7260
7261 @node File Framework
7262 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7263 @cindex assembler format
7264 @cindex output of assembler code
7265
7266 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7267 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7268
7269 @findex default_file_start
7270 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7271 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7272 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7273 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7274 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7275 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7276 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7277 @end deftypefn
7278
7279 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7280 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7281 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7282 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7283 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7284 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7285 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7286 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7287
7288 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7289 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7290 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7291 @end deftypevr
7292
7293 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7294 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7295 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7296 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7297 this to be done. The default is false.
7298 @end deftypevr
7299
7300 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7301 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7302 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7303 @end deftypefn
7304
7305 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7306 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7307 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7308 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7309 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7310 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7311 this function.
7312 @end deftypefun
7313
7314 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7315 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7316 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7317 nothing.
7318 @end deftypefn
7319
7320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7321 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7322 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7323 nothing.
7324 @end deftypefn
7325
7326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7327 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7328 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7329 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7330 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7331 nothing.
7332 @end deftypefn
7333
7334 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7335 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7336 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7337 the end of the line.
7338 @end defmac
7339
7340 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7341 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7342 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7343 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7344 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7345 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7346 @end defmac
7347
7348 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7349 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7350 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7351 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7352 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7353 @end defmac
7354
7355 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7356 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7357 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7358 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7359
7360 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7361 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7362 @end defmac
7363
7364 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7365 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7366
7367 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7368 @end deftypefn
7369
7370 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7371 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7372 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7373 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7374 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7375 of the filename using this macro.
7376 @end defmac
7377
7378 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7379 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7380 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7381 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7382 @end defmac
7383
7384 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7385 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7386 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7387 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7388 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7389 this section is associated.
7390 @end deftypefn
7391
7392 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7393 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7394 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7395 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7396 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7397 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7398 (from static destructors).
7399 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7400 @end deftypefn
7401
7402 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7403 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7404 @end deftypefn
7405
7406 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7407 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7408 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7409 @end deftypevr
7410
7411 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7412 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7413 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7414 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7415 This is true on most ELF targets.
7416 @end deftypevr
7417
7418 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7419 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7420 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7421 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7422 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7423
7424 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7425 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7426 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7427 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7428 @end deftypefn
7429
7430 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7431 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7432 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7433 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7434 It can take the following values:
7435
7436 @table @gcctabopt
7437 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7438 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7439
7440 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7441 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7442 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7443 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7444 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7445 various different individual optimization passes.
7446
7447 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7448 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7449 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7450 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7451 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7452 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7453 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7454 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7455 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7456 switches.
7457
7458 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7459 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7460
7461 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7462 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7463 @end table
7464
7465 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7466 supported in the future.
7467
7468 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7469 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7470 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7471 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7472 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7473 hook.
7474 @end deftypefn
7475
7476 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7477 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7478 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7479 hook.
7480 @end deftypevr
7481
7482 @need 2000
7483 @node Data Output
7484 @subsection Output of Data
7485
7486
7487 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7488 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7489 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7490 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7491 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7492 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7493 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7494 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7495 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7496 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7497 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7498 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7499 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7500 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7501
7502 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7503 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7504 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7505 @end deftypevr
7506
7507 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7508 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7509 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7510 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7511 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7512 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7513 split the object into smaller parts.
7514
7515 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7516 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7517 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7518 @end deftypefn
7519
7520 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7521 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7522 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7523 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7524 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7525
7526 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7527 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7528 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7529 return @code{true}.
7530 @end deftypefn
7531
7532 @defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7533 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7534 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7535 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7536 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7537
7538 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7539 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7540 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7541 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7542 @end defmac
7543
7544 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7545 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7546 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7547 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7548 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7549
7550 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7551 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7552 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7553 @end defmac
7554
7555 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7556 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7557 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7558 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7559 @end defmac
7560
7561 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7562 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7563 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7564 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7565 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7566 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7567 pool before the function.
7568 @end defmac
7569
7570 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7571 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7572 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7573 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7574 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7575 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7576 immediately after this call.
7577
7578 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7579 not be defined.
7580 @end defmac
7581
7582 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7583 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7584 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7585 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7586
7587 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7588 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7589 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7590 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7591 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7592 alignment.
7593
7594 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7595 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7596 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7597 Here is how to do this:
7598
7599 @smallexample
7600 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7601 @end smallexample
7602
7603 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7604 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7605 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7606
7607 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7608 @end defmac
7609
7610 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7611 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7612 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7613 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7614 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7615 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7616
7617 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7618 define this macro.
7619 @end defmac
7620
7621 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7622 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7623 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7624 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7625 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7626
7627 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7628 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7629 @end defmac
7630
7631 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7632 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7633 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7634 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7635 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7636 @end deftypevr
7637
7638 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7639 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7640
7641 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7642 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7643 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7644 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7645 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7646 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7647 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7648 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7649 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7650 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7651 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7652 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7653 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7654 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7655 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7656 on the host machine.
7657
7658 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7659 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7660 machine's memory.
7661 @end defmac
7662
7663 @node Uninitialized Data
7664 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7665
7666 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7667 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7668
7669 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7670 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7671 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7672 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7673 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7674 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7675 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7676 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7677 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7678 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7679 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7680 an ordinary undefined external.
7681
7682 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7683 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7684 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7685
7686 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7687 common global variables are output.
7688 @end defmac
7689
7690 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7691 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7692 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7693 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7694 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7695 as the number of bits.
7696 @end defmac
7697
7698 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7699 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7700 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7701 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7702 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7703 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7704 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7705 @end defmac
7706
7707 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7708 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7709 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7710 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7711 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7712
7713 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7714 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7715 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7716 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7717 the name, and a newline.
7718
7719 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7720 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7721 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7722 You do not need to do both.
7723
7724 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7725 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7726 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7727 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7728 common in order to save space in the object file.
7729 @end defmac
7730
7731 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7732 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7733 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7734 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7735 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7736
7737 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7738 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7739 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7740
7741 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7742 static variables are output.
7743 @end defmac
7744
7745 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7746 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7747 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7748 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7749 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7750 as the number of bits.
7751 @end defmac
7752
7753 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7754 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7755 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7756 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7757 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7758 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7759 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7760 @end defmac
7761
7762 @node Label Output
7763 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7764
7765 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7766 This is about outputting labels.
7767
7768 @findex assemble_name
7769 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7770 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7771 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7772 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7773 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7774 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7775 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7776 @end defmac
7777
7778 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7779 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7780 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7781 a function.
7782 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7783 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7784 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7785 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7786
7787 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7788 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7789 @end defmac
7790
7791 @findex assemble_name_raw
7792 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7793 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7794 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7795 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7796 that it is more efficient.
7797 @end defmac
7798
7799 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7800 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7801 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7802 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7803 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7804
7805 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7806 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7807 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7808 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7809 define this macro.
7810 @end defmac
7811
7812 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7813 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7814 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7815 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7816 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7817 provided.
7818 @end defmac
7819
7820 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7821 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7822 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7823 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7824 address.
7825
7826 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7827 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7828 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7829 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7830 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7831 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7832 @end defmac
7833
7834 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7835 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7836 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7837 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7838 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7839
7840 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7841 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7842 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7843 types at all, do not define this macro.
7844 @end defmac
7845
7846 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7847 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7848 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7849 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7850 the default is not to define this macro.
7851
7852 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7853 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7854 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7855 types at all, do not define this macro.
7856 @end defmac
7857
7858 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7859 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7860 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7861 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7862 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7863 you should not count on this.
7864
7865 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7866 definition of this macro is provided.
7867 @end defmac
7868
7869 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7870 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7871 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7872 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7873 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7874 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7875 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7876
7877 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7878 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7879
7880 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7881 of this macro.
7882 @end defmac
7883
7884 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7885 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7886 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7887 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7888 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7889 representing the function.
7890
7891 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7892
7893 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7894 of this macro.
7895 @end defmac
7896
7897 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7898 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7899 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7900 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7901 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7902 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7903
7904 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7905 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7906
7907 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7908 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7909 @end defmac
7910
7911 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7912 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7913 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7914 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7915 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7916 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7917 will be an internal label.
7918
7919 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7920 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7921
7922 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7923 @end deftypefn
7924
7925 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7926 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7927 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7928 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7929
7930 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7931 nothing.
7932 @end defmac
7933
7934 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7935 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7936 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7937 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7938 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7939 something about the size of the object.
7940
7941 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7942 nothing.
7943
7944 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7945 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7946 @end defmac
7947
7948 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7949 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7950 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7951 that is, available for reference from other files.
7952
7953 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7954 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7955 @end deftypefn
7956
7957 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7958 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7959 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7960 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7961
7962 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7963 @end deftypefn
7964
7965 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7966 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7967 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7968 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7969 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7970 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7971 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7972 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7973
7974 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7975 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7976 macro.
7977 @end defmac
7978
7979 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7980 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7981 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7982 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7983 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7984 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7985 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7986 to make @var{name} weak.
7987 @end defmac
7988
7989 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7990 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7991 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7992 declaration of @code{name}.
7993 @end defmac
7994
7995 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7996 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7997 supports weak symbols.
7998
7999 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8000 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8001 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8002 @end defmac
8003
8004 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8005 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8006
8007 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8008 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8009 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8010 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8011 @end defmac
8012
8013 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8014 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8015 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8016 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8017 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8018 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8019 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8020 @end defmac
8021
8022 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8023 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8024 semantics.
8025
8026 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8027 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8028 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8029 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8030 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8031 be emitted as one-only.
8032 @end defmac
8033
8034 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8035 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8036 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8037 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8038 @end deftypefn
8039
8040 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8041 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8042 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8043 The default is @code{0}.
8044
8045 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8046 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8047 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8048 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8049 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8050 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8051 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8052
8053 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8054 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8055 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8056 table of contents.
8057 @end defmac
8058
8059 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8060 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8061 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8062 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8063 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8064 declaration.
8065
8066 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8067 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8068 @end defmac
8069
8070 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8071 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8072 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8073 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8074 @end deftypefn
8075
8076 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8077 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8078 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8079 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8080 @end deftypefn
8081
8082 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8083 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8084 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8085 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8086 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8087 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8088 @end defmac
8089
8090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8091 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8092 @end deftypefn
8093
8094 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8095 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8096 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8097 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8098 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8099 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8100 @end defmac
8101
8102 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8103 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8104 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8105 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8106 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8107 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8108 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8109 being taken.
8110 @end defmac
8111
8112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8113 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8114 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8115
8116 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8117 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8118 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8119
8120 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8121 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8122 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8123 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8124 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8125
8126 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8127 @end deftypefn
8128
8129 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8130 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8131 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8132 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8133 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8134 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8135 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8136 bundles.
8137
8138 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8139 used.
8140 @end defmac
8141
8142 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8143 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8144 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8145
8146 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8147 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8148 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8149
8150 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8151 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8152 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8153 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8154 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8155 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8156 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8157 @end defmac
8158
8159 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8160 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8161 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8162 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8163 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8164
8165 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8166 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8167 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8168 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8169 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8170 internal static variables in different scopes.
8171
8172 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8173 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8174 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8175 between the name and the number will suffice.
8176
8177 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8178 which is correct for most systems.
8179 @end defmac
8180
8181 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8182 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8183 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8184
8185 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8186 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8187 correct for most systems.
8188 @end defmac
8189
8190 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8191 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8192 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8193 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8194 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8195 the tree nodes are available.
8196
8197 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8198 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8199 correct for most systems.
8200 @end defmac
8201
8202 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8203 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8204 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8205 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8206 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8207 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8208 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8209 @end defmac
8210
8211 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8212 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8213 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8214 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8215 an undefined weak symbol.
8216
8217 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8218 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8219 @end defmac
8220
8221 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8222 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8223 Objective-C methods.
8224
8225 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8226 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8227 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8228 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8229
8230 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8231 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8232 systems define other ways of computing names.
8233
8234 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8235 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8236 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8237 50 characters extra.
8238
8239 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8240 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8241 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8242 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8243
8244 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8245 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8246 @end defmac
8247
8248 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8249 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8250 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8251 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8252 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8253 @end defmac
8254
8255 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8256 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8257 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8258 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8259 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8260 @end defmac
8261
8262 @node Initialization
8263 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8264 @cindex initialization routines
8265 @cindex termination routines
8266 @cindex constructors, output of
8267 @cindex destructors, output of
8268
8269 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8270 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8271 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8272 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8273 @code{main} is called.
8274
8275 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8276 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8277 terminates.
8278
8279 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8280 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8281 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8282 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8283
8284 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8285 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8286 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8287
8288 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8289 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8290 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8291 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8292 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8293
8294 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8295 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8296 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8297 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8298 pointer containing zero.
8299
8300 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8301 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8302 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8303 list; destructors in forward order.
8304
8305 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8306 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8307 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8308 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8309 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8310 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8311 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8312 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8313
8314 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8315 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8316 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8317 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8318 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8319
8320 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8321 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8322 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8323 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8324 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8325
8326 @smallexample
8327 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8328 @end smallexample
8329
8330 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8331 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8332 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8333 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8334 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8335
8336 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8337 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8338 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8339 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8340 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8341 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8342
8343 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8344 macro properly.
8345
8346 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8347 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8348 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8349 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8350 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8351 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8352
8353 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8354 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8355 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8356 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8357 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8358 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8359 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8360 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8361 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8362 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8363 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8364 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8365 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8366 the initialization process.
8367
8368 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8369 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8370 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8371 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8372 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8373 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8374 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8375 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8376 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8377 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8378 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8379
8380 @ifinfo
8381 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8382 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8383 @end ifinfo
8384
8385 @node Macros for Initialization
8386 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8387
8388 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8389 and termination functions:
8390
8391 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8392 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8393 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8394 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8395 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8396 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8397 run the initialization functions.
8398 @end defmac
8399
8400 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8401 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8402 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8403 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8404 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8405 @end defmac
8406
8407 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8408 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8409 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8410 @end defmac
8411
8412 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8413 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8414 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8415 @end defmac
8416
8417 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8418 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8419 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8420 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8421 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8422 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8423
8424 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8425 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8426 exception tables embedded in the code.
8427 @end defmac
8428
8429 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8430 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8431 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8432 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8433 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8434 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8435 @end defmac
8436
8437 @defmac INVOKE__main
8438 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8439 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8440 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8441 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8442 @end defmac
8443
8444 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8445 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8446 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8447 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8448 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8449 @end defmac
8450
8451 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8452 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8453 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8454 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8455 @end deftypevr
8456
8457 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8458 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8459 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8460
8461 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8462 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8463 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8464 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8465
8466 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8467 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8468 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8469 is not defined.
8470 @end deftypefn
8471
8472 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8473 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8474 functions rather than initialization functions.
8475 @end deftypefn
8476
8477 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8478 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8479
8480 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8481 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8482 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8483
8484 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8485 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8486
8487 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8488 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8489 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8490 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8491
8492 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8493 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8494 @end defmac
8495
8496 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8497 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8498 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8499 @command{nm}.
8500 @end defmac
8501
8502 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8503 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8504 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8505 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8506 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8507 produces.
8508 @end defmac
8509
8510 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8511 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8512 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8513 termination functions in shared libraries:
8514
8515 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8516 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8517 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8518 @end defmac
8519
8520 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8521 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8522 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8523 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8524 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8525 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8526 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8527 @end defmac
8528
8529 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8530 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8531 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8532 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8533 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8534 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8535 @end defmac
8536
8537 @node Instruction Output
8538 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8539
8540 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8541 This describes assembler instruction output.
8542
8543 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8544 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8545 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8546 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8547 @end defmac
8548
8549 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8550 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8551 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8552 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8553 to registers using alternate names.
8554 @end defmac
8555
8556 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8557 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8558 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8559 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8560 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8561 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8562 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8563 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8564
8565 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8566 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8567 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8568 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8569 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8570 @end defmac
8571
8572 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8573 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8574 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8575
8576 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8577 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8578 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8579 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8580 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8581 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8582 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8583 so that it will not be output twice.
8584
8585 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8586 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8587 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8588 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8589 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8590
8591 @findex recog_data.operand
8592 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8593 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8594
8595 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8596 in the usual way.
8597 @end defmac
8598
8599 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8600 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8601 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8602 they will be output differently.
8603
8604 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8605 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8606 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8607 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8608 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8609 by changing the contents of the vector.
8610
8611 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8612 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8613 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8614 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8615 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8616 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8617
8618 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8619 @end defmac
8620
8621 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8622 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8623 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8624 if necessary.
8625
8626 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8627 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8628 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8629 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8630 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8631 by checking the contents of the vector.
8632 @end deftypefn
8633
8634 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8635 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8636 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8637 RTL expression.
8638
8639 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8640 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8641 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8642 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8643 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8644 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8645 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8646
8647 @findex reg_names
8648 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8649 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8650 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8651 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8652
8653 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8654 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8655 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8656 @var{code}.
8657 @end defmac
8658
8659 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8660 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8661 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8662 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8663 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8664 in this way.
8665 @end defmac
8666
8667 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8668 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8669 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8670 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8671
8672 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8673 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8674 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8675 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8676 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8677 Format}.
8678 @end defmac
8679
8680 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8681 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8682 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8683 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8684 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8685 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8686 or whatever.
8687
8688 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8689 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8690 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8691 @end defmac
8692
8693 @findex final_sequence
8694 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8695 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8696 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8697 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8698 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8699 being output.
8700
8701 @findex asm_fprintf
8702 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8703 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8704 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8705 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8706 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8707 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8708 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8709 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8710 files can define these macros differently.
8711 @end defmac
8712
8713 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8714 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8715 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8716 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8717 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8718 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8719 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8720 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8721 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8722 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8723 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8724 @end defmac
8725
8726 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8727 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8728 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8729 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8730 first variant.
8731
8732 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8733 @smallexample
8734 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8735 @end smallexample
8736 @noindent
8737 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8738 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8739 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8740 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8741 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8742 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8743 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8744
8745 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8746 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8747 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8748
8749 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8750 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8751 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8752 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8753 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8754 opcodes or operand order.
8755 @end defmac
8756
8757 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8758 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8759 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8760 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8761 profiling.
8762 @end defmac
8763
8764 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8765 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8766 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8767 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8768 profiling.
8769 @end defmac
8770
8771 @node Dispatch Tables
8772 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8773
8774 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8775 This concerns dispatch tables.
8776
8777 @cindex dispatch table
8778 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8779 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8780 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8781 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8782 definitions of these labels are output using
8783 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8784 way here. For example,
8785
8786 @smallexample
8787 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8788 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8789 @end smallexample
8790
8791 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8792 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8793 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8794 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8795 mode and flags can be read.
8796 @end defmac
8797
8798 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8799 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8800 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8801
8802 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8803 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8804 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8805 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8806 For example,
8807
8808 @smallexample
8809 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8810 @end smallexample
8811 @end defmac
8812
8813 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8814 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8815 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8816 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8817 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8818 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8819
8820 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8821 for the table.
8822
8823 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8824 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8825 @end defmac
8826
8827 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8828 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8829 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8830 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8831 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8832 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8833 of the preceding label.
8834
8835 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8836 the jump-table.
8837 @end defmac
8838
8839 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8840 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8841 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8842 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8843 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8844 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8845 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8846 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8847
8848 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8849 @end deftypefn
8850
8851 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
8852 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8853 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8854 to be broken up according to function.
8855
8856 The default is that no label is emitted.
8857 @end deftypefn
8858
8859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8860 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8861 @end deftypefn
8862
8863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
8864 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8865 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8866 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8867 @end deftypefn
8868
8869 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8870 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8871 @end deftypevr
8872
8873 @node Exception Region Output
8874 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8875
8876 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8877
8878 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8879 region.
8880
8881 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8882 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8883 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8884 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8885 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8886
8887 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8888 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8889 @end defmac
8890
8891 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8892 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8893 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8894 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8895 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8896
8897 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8898 also defined.
8899 @end defmac
8900
8901 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8902 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8903 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8904 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8905 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8906 @end defmac
8907
8908 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8909 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8910 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8911 @end defmac
8912
8913 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8914 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8915 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8916 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8917 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8918 or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8919 @end defmac
8920
8921 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
8922 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8923 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8924 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8925 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8926 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8927 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8928
8929 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8930 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8931 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8932
8933 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8934 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8935 @var{opts}. In particular, the
8936 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8937 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8938 depending on this setting.
8939
8940 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8941 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8942 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8943 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8944 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8945 @end deftypefn
8946
8947 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8948 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8949 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8950 command-line option processing.
8951 @end deftypevr
8952
8953 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8954 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8955 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8956 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8957 @end defmac
8958
8959 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8960 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8961 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8962 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8963 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8964 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8965 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8966 @end defmac
8967
8968 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8969 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8970 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8971 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8972 true otherwise.
8973 @end deftypevr
8974
8975 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8976 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8977 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8978 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8979 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8980 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8981 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8982 @end deftypefn
8983
8984 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
8985 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8986 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8987 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8988 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8989 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8990 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8991 @end deftypefn
8992
8993 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
8994 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8995 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8996 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8997 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8998 @end deftypefn
8999
9000 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9001 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9002 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9003 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9004 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9005 @end deftypevr
9006
9007 @node Alignment Output
9008 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9009
9010 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9011 This describes commands for alignment.
9012
9013 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9014 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9015 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9016
9017 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9018 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9019 define the macro.
9020
9021 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9022 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9023 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9024 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9025 @end defmac
9026
9027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9028 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9029 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9030 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9031 @end deftypefn
9032
9033 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9034 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9035 a @code{BARRIER}.
9036
9037 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9038 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9039 define the macro.
9040 @end defmac
9041
9042 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9043 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9044 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9045 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9046 @end deftypefn
9047
9048 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9049 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9050 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
9051
9052 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9053 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9054 define the macro.
9055
9056 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9057 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9058 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9059 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9060 @end defmac
9061
9062 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9063 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9064 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9065 defined.
9066 @end deftypefn
9067
9068 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9069 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9070 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9071 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9072
9073 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9074 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9075 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9076 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9077 @end defmac
9078
9079 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9080 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9081 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9082 is defined.
9083 @end deftypefn
9084
9085 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9086 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9087 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9088 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9089 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9090 @end defmac
9091
9092 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9093 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9094 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9095 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9096 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9097 section.
9098 @end defmac
9099
9100 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9101 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9102 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9103 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9104 @end defmac
9105
9106 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9107 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9108 for padding, if necessary.
9109 @end defmac
9110
9111 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9112 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9113 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9114 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9115 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9116 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9117 @end defmac
9118
9119 @need 3000
9120 @node Debugging Info
9121 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9122
9123 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9124 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9125
9126 @menu
9127 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9128 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9129 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9130 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9131 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9132 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9133 @end menu
9134
9135 @node All Debuggers
9136 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9137
9138 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9139 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9140
9141 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9142 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9143 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9144 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9145 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9146 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9147 compiler and another for DBX@.
9148
9149 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9150 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9151 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9152 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9153 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9154
9155 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9156 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9157 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9158 @end defmac
9159
9160 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9161 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9162 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9163 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9164 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9165 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9166 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9167 @option{-g} options is used.
9168 @end defmac
9169
9170 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9171 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9172 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9173 @var{offset}.
9174 @end defmac
9175
9176 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9177 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9178 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9179 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9180 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9181 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9182 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9183
9184 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9185 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9186 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9187 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9188 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9189
9190 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9191 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9192 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9193 @end defmac
9194
9195 @node DBX Options
9196 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9197
9198 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9199 These are specific options for DBX output.
9200
9201 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9202 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9203 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9204 @end defmac
9205
9206 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9207 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9208 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9209 @end defmac
9210
9211 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9212 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9213 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9214 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9215 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9216 if there is any occasion to.
9217 @end defmac
9218
9219 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9220 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9221 in the text section.
9222 @end defmac
9223
9224 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9225 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9226 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9227 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9228 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9229 @end defmac
9230
9231 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9232 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9233 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9234 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9235 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9236 information format.
9237 @end defmac
9238
9239 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9240 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9241 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9242 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9243 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9244 @end defmac
9245
9246 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9247 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9248 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9249 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9250 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9251 @end defmac
9252
9253 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9254 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9255 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9256 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9257 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9258 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9259 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9260 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9261 @end defmac
9262
9263 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9264 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9265 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9266 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9267 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9268 if backslash is correct for your system.
9269 @end defmac
9270
9271 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9272 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9273 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9274 variable.
9275 @end defmac
9276
9277 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9278 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9279 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9280 @end defmac
9281
9282 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9283 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9284 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9285 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9286 @end defmac
9287
9288 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9289 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9290 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9291 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9292 @end defmac
9293
9294 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9295 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9296 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9297 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9298 @end defmac
9299
9300 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9301 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9302 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9303 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9304 code.
9305 @end defmac
9306
9307 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9308 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9309 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9310 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9311 an absolute address.
9312 @end defmac
9313
9314 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9315 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9316 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9317 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9318 @end defmac
9319
9320 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9321 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9322 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9323 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9324 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9325 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9326 number for a type number.
9327 @end defmac
9328
9329 @node DBX Hooks
9330 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9331
9332 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9333 These are hooks for DBX format.
9334
9335 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9336 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9337 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9338 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9339 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9340 @end defmac
9341
9342 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9343 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9344 @end defmac
9345
9346 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9347 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9348 output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9349 @end defmac
9350
9351 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9352 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9353 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9354 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9355 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9356 unique labels in the assembly output.
9357
9358 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9359 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9360 @end defmac
9361
9362 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9363 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9364 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9365 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9366 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9367 @end defmac
9368
9369 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9370 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9371 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9372 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9373 @end defmac
9374
9375 @node File Names and DBX
9376 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9377
9378 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9379 This describes file names in DBX format.
9380
9381 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9382 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9383 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9384 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9385 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9386
9387 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9388 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9389
9390 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9391 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9392 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9393 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9394 @end defmac
9395
9396 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9397 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9398 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9399 the beginning of the file.
9400 @end defmac
9401
9402 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9403 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9404 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9405 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9406 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9407 @end defmac
9408
9409 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9410 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9411 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9412 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9413
9414 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9415 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9416 @end defmac
9417
9418 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9419 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9420 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9421 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9422 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9423 @end defmac
9424
9425 @need 2000
9426 @node SDB and DWARF
9427 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9428
9429 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9430 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9431
9432 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9433 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9434 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9435 @end defmac
9436
9437 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9438 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9439 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9440
9441 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9442 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9443 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9444 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9445 @end deftypefn
9446
9447 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9448 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9449 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9450 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9451 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9452 @end defmac
9453
9454 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9455 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9456 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9457 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9458 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9459 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9460 @end defmac
9461
9462 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9463 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9464 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9465 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9466 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9467
9468 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9469 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9470
9471 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9472 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9473 @end deftypefn
9474
9475 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9476 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9477 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9478 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9479 @end defmac
9480
9481 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9482 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9483 @end deftypevr
9484
9485 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9486 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9487 @end deftypevr
9488
9489 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9490 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9491 @end deftypevr
9492
9493 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9494 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9495 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9496 @end defmac
9497
9498 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9499 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9500 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9501 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9502 @end defmac
9503
9504 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9505 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9506 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9507 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9508 @end defmac
9509
9510 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9511 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9512 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9513 @end defmac
9514
9515 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9516 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9517 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9518 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9519 is referenced by a function.
9520 @end defmac
9521
9522 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9523 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9524 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9525 @end deftypefn
9526
9527 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9528 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9529 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9530 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9531 not define them yourself.
9532 @end defmac
9533
9534 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9535 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9536 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9537 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9538 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9539 required.
9540 @end defmac
9541
9542 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9543 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9544 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9545 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9546 it.
9547 @end defmac
9548
9549 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9550 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9551 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9552 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9553 @end defmac
9554
9555 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9556 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9557 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9558 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9559 @end defmac
9560
9561 @need 2000
9562 @node VMS Debug
9563 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9564
9565 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9566 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9567
9568 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9569 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9570 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9571 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9572 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9573 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9574 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9575 @end defmac
9576
9577 @node Floating Point
9578 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9579 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9580 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9581
9582 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9583 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9584 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9585 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9586 doing the compilation.
9587
9588 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9589 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9590 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9591 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9592 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9593 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9594 target floating point formats are identical.
9595
9596 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9597 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9598 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9599 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9600
9601 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9602 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9603 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9604 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9605 quantity.
9606 @end defmac
9607
9608 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9609 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9610 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9611 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9612 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9613 @end deftypefn
9614
9615 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9616 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9617 @end deftypefn
9618
9619 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9620 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9621 @end deftypefn
9622
9623 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9624 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9625 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9626 @end deftypefn
9627
9628 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9629 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9630 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9631 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9632 defined by the C language for both.
9633 @end deftypefn
9634
9635 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9636 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9637 @end deftypefn
9638
9639 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9640 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9641 @end deftypefn
9642
9643 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9644 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9645 @end deftypefn
9646
9647 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9648 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9649 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9650 variable).
9651
9652 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9653 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9654 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9655
9656 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9657 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9658 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9659 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9660 @end deftypefn
9661
9662 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9663 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9664 @end deftypefn
9665
9666 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9667 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9668 @end deftypefn
9669
9670 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9671 Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9672 return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9673 appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9674 precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9675 @end deftypefn
9676
9677 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9678 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9679 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9680 integral, it is truncated.
9681 @end deftypefn
9682
9683 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9684 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9685 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9686 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9687 @end deftypefn
9688
9689 @node Mode Switching
9690 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9691 @cindex mode switching
9692 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9693
9694 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9695 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9696 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9697
9698 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9699 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9700 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9701 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9702 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9703 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9704 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9705
9706 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9707 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9708 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9709 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9710 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9711 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9712 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9713 are optional.
9714 @end defmac
9715
9716 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9717 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9718 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9719 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9720 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9721 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9722 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9723 entity in question.
9724 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9725 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9726 switch is needed / supplied.
9727 @end defmac
9728
9729 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9730 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9731 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9732 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9733 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9734 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9735 @end defmac
9736
9737 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9738 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9739 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9740 different from the incoming mode).
9741 @end defmac
9742
9743 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9744 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9745 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9746 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9747 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9748 @end defmac
9749
9750 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9751 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9752 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9753 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9754 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9755 @end defmac
9756
9757 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9758 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9759 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9760 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9761 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9762 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9763 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9764 @end defmac
9765
9766 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9767 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9768 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9769 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9770 @end defmac
9771
9772 @node Target Attributes
9773 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9774 @cindex target attributes
9775 @cindex machine attributes
9776 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9777
9778 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9779 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9780 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9781
9782 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9783 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9784 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9785 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9786 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9787 take.
9788 @end deftypevr
9789
9790 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9791 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9792 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9793 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9794 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9795 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9796 @end deftypefn
9797
9798 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9799 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9800 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9801 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9802 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9803 supposed always to be compatible.
9804 @end deftypefn
9805
9806 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9807 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9808 the newly defined @var{type}.
9809 @end deftypefn
9810
9811 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9812 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9813 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9814 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9815 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9816 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9817 merging.
9818 @end deftypefn
9819
9820 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9821 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9822 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9823 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9824 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9825 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9826 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9827 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9828
9829 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9830 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9831 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9832 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9833 will then define a function called
9834 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9835 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9836 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9837 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9838 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9839 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9840 @end deftypefn
9841
9842 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9843 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9844 @end deftypefn
9845
9846 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9847 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9848 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9849 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9850 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9851 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9852 on this implementation detail.
9853 @end defmac
9854
9855 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9856 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9857 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9858 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9859 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9860 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9861 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9862 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9863 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9864 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9865 needed.
9866 @end deftypefn
9867
9868 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9869 @cindex inlining
9870 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9871 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9872 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9873 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9874 @end deftypefn
9875
9876 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9877 This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9878 it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9879 options for the current function that might be different than the
9880 options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9881 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9882
9883 The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9884 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9885 @var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9886 @end deftypefn
9887
9888 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9889 This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9890 in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9891 options.
9892 @xref{Option file format}.
9893 @end deftypefn
9894
9895 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9896 This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9897 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9898 function specific options.
9899 @end deftypefn
9900
9901 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9902 This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9903 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9904 function specific options.
9905 @end deftypefn
9906
9907 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
9908 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9909 set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9910 input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9911 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9912 @end deftypefn
9913
9914 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9915 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9916 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9917 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9918 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9919
9920 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9921 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9922
9923 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9924 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9925 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9926 @end deftypefn
9927
9928 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9929 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9930 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9931 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9932 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9933 @end deftypefn
9934
9935 @node Emulated TLS
9936 @section Emulating TLS
9937 @cindex Emulated TLS
9938
9939 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9940 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9941 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9942 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9943 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9944 layer.
9945
9946 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9947 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9948 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9949 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9950
9951 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9952 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9953 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9954 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9955 @end deftypevr
9956
9957 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9958 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9959 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9960 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9961 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9962 registration function to be used.
9963 @end deftypevr
9964
9965 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9966 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9967 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9968 any section.
9969 @end deftypevr
9970
9971 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9972 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9973 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9974 section.
9975 @end deftypevr
9976
9977 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9978 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9979 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9980 @end deftypevr
9981
9982 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9983 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9984 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9985 @end deftypevr
9986
9987 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9988 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9989 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9990 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9991 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9992 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9993 @end deftypefn
9994
9995 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
9996 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9997 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9998 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9999 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10000 @end deftypefn
10001
10002 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10003 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10004 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10005 single objects. The default is false.
10006 @end deftypevr
10007
10008 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10009 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10010 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10011 @end deftypevr
10012
10013 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10014 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10015 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10016
10017 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10018 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10019 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10020 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10021
10022 @smallexample
10023 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10024 unsigned int d;
10025
10026 d = cp0count + 3;
10027 @end smallexample
10028
10029 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10030 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10031 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10032
10033 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10034 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10035 later in the function.
10036
10037 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10038 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10039 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10040
10041 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
10042 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
10043
10044 @defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
10045 A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
10046 alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
10047 @smallexample
10048 @{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
10049 @end smallexample
10050 Default: empty.
10051 @end defmac
10052
10053 @node PCH Target
10054 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10055 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10056
10057 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10058 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10059 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10060 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10061 @end deftypefn
10062
10063 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10064 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10065 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10066 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10067 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10068
10069 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10070 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10071 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10072 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10073
10074 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10075 suitable for most targets.
10076 @end deftypefn
10077
10078 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10079 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10080 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10081 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10082 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10083 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10084 @end deftypefn
10085
10086 @node C++ ABI
10087 @section C++ ABI parameters
10088 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10089
10090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10091 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10092 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10093 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10094 @end deftypefn
10095
10096 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10097 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10098 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10099 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10100 @end deftypefn
10101
10102 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10103 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10104 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10105 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10106 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10107 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10108 @end deftypefn
10109
10110 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10111 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10112 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10113 @end deftypefn
10114
10115 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10116 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10117 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10118 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10119 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10120 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10121 backend's targeted operating system.
10122 @end deftypefn
10123
10124 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10125 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10126 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10127 @code{false}.
10128 @end deftypefn
10129
10130 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10131 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10132 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10133 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10134 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10135 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10136 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10137 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10138 @end deftypefn
10139
10140 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10141 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10142 @end deftypefn
10143
10144 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10145 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10146 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10147 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10148 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10149 unit will not be COMDAT.
10150 @end deftypefn
10151
10152 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10153 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10154 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10155 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10156 @end deftypefn
10157
10158 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10159 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10160 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10161 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10162 @end deftypefn
10163
10164 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10165 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10166 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10167 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10168 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10169 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10170 @end deftypefn
10171
10172 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10173 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10174 @end deftypefn
10175
10176 @node Named Address Spaces
10177 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10178 @cindex named address spaces
10179
10180 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10181 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10182 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10183 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10184 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10185 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10186 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10187 @code{const} type attributes.
10188
10189 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10190 pointers to the generic address space.
10191
10192 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10193 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10194 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10195 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10196 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10197 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10198 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10199 always 32 bits).
10200
10201 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10202 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10203 address space.
10204
10205 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10206 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10207 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10208 named address space #1:
10209 @smallexample
10210 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10211 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10212 @end smallexample
10213
10214 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10215 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10216 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10217 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10218 generic address space only.
10219 @end deftypefn
10220
10221 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10222 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10223 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10224 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10225 generic address space only.
10226 @end deftypefn
10227
10228 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10229 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10230 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10231 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10232 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10233 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10234 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10235 target hooks for the given address space.
10236 @end deftypefn
10237
10238 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10239 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10240 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10241 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10242 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10243 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10244 explicit named address space support.
10245 @end deftypefn
10246
10247 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10248 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10249 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10250 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10251 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10252 @end deftypefn
10253
10254 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{superset}, addr_space_t @var{subset})
10255 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10256 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10257 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10258 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10259 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10260 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10261 @end deftypefn
10262
10263 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10264 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10265 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10266 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10267 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10268 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10269 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10270 @end deftypefn
10271
10272 @node Misc
10273 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10274 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10275
10276 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10277 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10278
10279 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10280 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10281 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10282 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10283 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10284 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10285 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10286 @end defmac
10287
10288 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10289 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10290 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10291 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10292 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10293 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10294 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10295 @end defmac
10296
10297 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10298 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10299 elements of a jump-table should have.
10300 @end defmac
10301
10302 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10303 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10304 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10305 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10306 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10307 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10308 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10309 flags can be updated.
10310 @end defmac
10311
10312 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10313 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10314 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10315 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10316 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10317 is in effect.
10318 @end defmac
10319
10320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10321 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10322 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10323 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10324 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10325 @end deftypefn
10326
10327 @defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10328 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10329 statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10330 advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10331 of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10332 targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10333 @code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10334 @code{false} otherwise.
10335 @end defmac
10336
10337 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10338 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10339 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10340 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10341 @end defmac
10342
10343 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10344 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10345 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10346 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10347 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10348 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10349 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10350 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10351
10352 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10353 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10354 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10355 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10356 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10357
10358 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10359 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10360 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10361 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10362 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10363
10364 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10365 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10366 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10367 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10368 @end defmac
10369
10370 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10371 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10372 extends.
10373 @end defmac
10374
10375 @defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10376 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10377 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10378 unsigned one.
10379 @end defmac
10380
10381 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10382 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10383 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10384 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10385 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10386 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10387 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10388 @end deftypefn
10389
10390 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10391 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10392 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10393 @end defmac
10394
10395 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10396 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10397 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10398 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10399 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10400 at run-time.
10401 @end defmac
10402
10403 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10404 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10405 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10406 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10407 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10408 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10409 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10410 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10411 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10412 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10413 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10414
10415 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10416 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10417 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10418
10419 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10420 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10421 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10422 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10423 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10424
10425 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10426 @end defmac
10427
10428 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10429 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10430 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10431 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10432 @xref{shift patterns}.
10433
10434 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10435 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10436 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10437 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10438 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10439 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10440
10441 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10442 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10443 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10444
10445 The default implementation of this function returns
10446 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10447 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10448 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10449 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10450 by overriding it.
10451 @end deftypefn
10452
10453 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10454 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10455 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10456 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10457 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10458
10459 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10460
10461 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10462 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10463 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10464 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10465 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10466 such cases may improve things.
10467 @end defmac
10468
10469 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10470 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10471 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10472 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10473 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10474 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10475 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10476 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10477 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10478 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10479 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10480
10481 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10482 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10483 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10484 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10485
10486 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10487 describe two related properties. If you define
10488 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10489 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10490 extension.
10491
10492 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10493 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10494 @code{mode}.
10495 @end deftypefn
10496
10497 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10498 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10499 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10500 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10501 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10502 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10503
10504 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10505 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10506 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10507 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10508 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10509 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10510 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10511 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10512 the compiler.
10513
10514 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10515 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10516 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10517 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10518 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10519 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10520 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10521 expression
10522
10523 @smallexample
10524 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10525 @end smallexample
10526
10527 @noindent
10528 can be converted to
10529
10530 @smallexample
10531 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10532 @end smallexample
10533
10534 @noindent
10535 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10536 tested into the sign bit.
10537
10538 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10539 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10540 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10541 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10542 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10543 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10544
10545 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10546 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10547 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10548 to be used:
10549
10550 @itemize @bullet
10551 @item
10552 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10553 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10554 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10555 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10556 combine the normalization with other operations.
10557
10558 @item
10559 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10560 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10561 other machines.
10562
10563 @item
10564 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10565 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10566 others.
10567
10568 @item
10569 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10570 @end itemize
10571
10572 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10573 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10574 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10575 those cases, e.g., one matching
10576
10577 @smallexample
10578 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10579 @end smallexample
10580
10581 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10582 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10583 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10584 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10585 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10586 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10587 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10588 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10589
10590 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10591 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10592 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10593 @end defmac
10594
10595 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10596 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10597 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10598 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10599 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10600 this macro.
10601 @end defmac
10602
10603 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10604 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10605 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10606 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10607 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10608 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10609 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10610 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10611 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10612 given mode.
10613 @end defmac
10614
10615 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10616 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10617 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10618 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10619 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10620 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10621 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10622 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10623 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10624 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10625 this value.
10626
10627 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10628 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10629
10630 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10631 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10632 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10633 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10634
10635 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10636 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10637 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10638 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10639 breaking the API@.
10640 @end defmac
10641
10642 @defmac Pmode
10643 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10644 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10645 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10646 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10647 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10648
10649 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10650 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10651 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10652 to @code{Pmode}.
10653 @end defmac
10654
10655 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10656 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10657 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10658 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10659 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10660 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10661 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10662 @end defmac
10663
10664 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10665 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10666 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10667 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10668 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10669 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10670
10671 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10672 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10673 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10674 @end defmac
10675
10676 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10677 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10678 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10679 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10680 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10681 @end defmac
10682
10683 @findex #pragma
10684 @findex pragma
10685 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10686 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10687 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10688 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10689 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10690 setup required for the pragmas.
10691
10692 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10693 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10694 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10695
10696 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10697 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10698
10699 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10700 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10701 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10702 @end defmac
10703
10704 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10705 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10706
10707 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10708 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10709 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10710 pragma of the form
10711
10712 @smallexample
10713 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10714 @end smallexample
10715
10716 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10717 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10718 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10719 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10720 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10721 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10722 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10723 arguments of pragmas registered with
10724 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10725 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10726
10727 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10728 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10729 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10730 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10731 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10732 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10733 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10734 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10735 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10736 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10737 how to build this object file.
10738 @end deftypefun
10739
10740 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10741 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10742 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10743 @end defmac
10744
10745 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10746 True if @code{#pragma extern_prefix} is to be supported.
10747 @end deftypevr
10748
10749 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10750 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10751 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10752 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10753 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10754 @end defmac
10755
10756 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10757 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10758 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10759 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10760 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10761 @end defmac
10762
10763 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10764 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10765 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10766 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10767 @samp{.} is used instead.
10768 @end defmac
10769
10770 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10771 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10772 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10773 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10774 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10775 @end defmac
10776
10777 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10778 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10779 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10780 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10781 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10782 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10783 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10784 you should define this macro.
10785
10786 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10787 @end defmac
10788
10789 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10790 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10791 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10792 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10793 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10794 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10795 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10796 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10797 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10798 slot of @var{insn}.
10799
10800 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10801 @end defmac
10802
10803 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10804 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10805 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10806 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10807 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10808 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10809
10810 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10811 @end defmac
10812
10813 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
10814 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10815 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10816 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10817 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10818 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10819 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10820 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10821 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10822 @end deftypefn
10823
10824 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10825 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10826 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10827 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10828 separate math library.
10829
10830 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10831 @end defmac
10832
10833 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10834 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10835 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10836
10837 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10838 is wrong.
10839 @end defmac
10840
10841 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10842 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10843 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10844 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10845 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10846 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10847 for cross-profiling.
10848 @end defmac
10849
10850 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10851
10852 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10853 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10854 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10855 1 if it does use cc0.
10856 @end defmac
10857
10858 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10859 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10860 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10861 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10862 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10863 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10864 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10865 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10866 @end defmac
10867
10868 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10869 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10870 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10871 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10872 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10873 @end defmac
10874
10875 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10876 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10877 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10878 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10879 about the currently processed blocks.
10880 @end defmac
10881
10882 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10883 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10884 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10885 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10886 to by @var{ce_info}.
10887 @end defmac
10888
10889 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10890 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10891 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10892 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10893 to by @var{ce_info}.
10894 @end defmac
10895
10896 @defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10897 A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10898 structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10899 @end defmac
10900
10901 @defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10902 If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10903 added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10904 by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10905 @end defmac
10906
10907 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
10908 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10909 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10910 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10911
10912 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10913 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10914 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10915 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10916
10917 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10918 definition is null.
10919 @end deftypefn
10920
10921 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
10922 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10923 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10924 necessary setup.
10925
10926 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10927 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10928 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10929 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10930
10931 To create a built-in function, call the function
10932 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10933 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10934 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
10935 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10936 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10937 @end deftypefn
10938
10939 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
10940 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10941 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10942 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10943 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10944 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10945 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10946 @code{error_mark_node}.
10947 @end deftypefn
10948
10949 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
10950
10951 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10952 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10953 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10954 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10955 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10956 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10957 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10958 built-in function.
10959 @end deftypefn
10960
10961 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
10962 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10963 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10964 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10965 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10966 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10967 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10968 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10969 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10970 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10971 @end deftypefn
10972
10973 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
10974 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10975 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10976 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10977 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10978 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10979 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10980 @end deftypefn
10981
10982 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
10983
10984 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10985 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10986 could not be applied.
10987
10988 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10989 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10990 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10991 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10992 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10993 @end deftypefn
10994
10995 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10996
10997 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10998 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10999 @var{branch2} is possible.
11000
11001 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
11002 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
11003 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
11004 @end defmac
11005
11006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11007 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11008 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11009 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11010 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11011 @end deftypefn
11012
11013 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11014
11015 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11016 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11017 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11018 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11019 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11020 that had its initial value copied by using
11021 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11022 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11023 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11024 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11025 @code{MEM}.
11026 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11027 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11028 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
11029 that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
11030 register in question will not be clobbered.
11031 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11032 allocation.
11033 @end deftypefn
11034
11035 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11036 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11037 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11038 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11039 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11040 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11041 passed along.
11042 @end deftypefn
11043
11044 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11045 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11046 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11047 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11048 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11049 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11050 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11051 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11052 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11053 The default hook function does nothing.
11054
11055 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11056 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11057 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11058 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11059 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11060 outside of any function scope.
11061 @end deftypefn
11062
11063 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11064 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11065 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11066 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11067 @end defmac
11068
11069 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11070 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11071 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11072 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11073 executable files.
11074 @end defmac
11075
11076 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11077 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11078 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11079 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11080 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11081 lists.
11082 @end defmac
11083
11084 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11085 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11086 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11087 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11088 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11089 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11090 defined as this expression:
11091
11092 @smallexample
11093 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11094 build_tree_list
11095 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11096 NULL))
11097 @end smallexample
11098 @end defmac
11099
11100 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11101 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11102 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11103 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11104 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11105
11106 @smallexample
11107 static bool
11108 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11109 @{
11110 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11111 @}
11112 @end smallexample
11113 @end deftypefn
11114
11115 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11116 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11117 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11118 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11119 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11120 to inter-block scheduling.
11121 @end deftypefn
11122
11123 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11124 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11125 registers
11126 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11127 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11128 that all target registers in the class returned by
11129 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11130 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11131 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11132 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11133 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11134 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11135 @end deftypefn
11136
11137 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11138 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11139 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11140 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11141 @end deftypefn
11142
11143 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11144 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11145 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11146 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11147 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11148 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11149 number of memory accesses.
11150 @end deftypefn
11151
11152 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11153 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11154 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11155 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11156 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11157 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11158 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11159 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11160 @end defmac
11161
11162 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11163 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11164 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11165 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11166 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11167 @end deftypefn
11168
11169 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11170 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11171 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11172 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11173 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11174 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11175 @end deftypefn
11176
11177 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11178 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11179 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11180 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11181 that are different from @option{-I}.
11182 @end deftypefn
11183
11184 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11185 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11186 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11187 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11188 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11189 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11190 @end defmac
11191
11192 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11193 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11194 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11195 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11196 @end defmac
11197
11198 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11199 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11200 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11201 @end defmac
11202
11203 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11204 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11205 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11206 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11207 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11208 @end defmac
11209
11210 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11211 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11212 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11213 @end defmac
11214
11215 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11216 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11217 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11218 and scanf formatter settings.
11219 @end defmac
11220
11221 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11222 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11223 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11224 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11225 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11226 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11227 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11228 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11229 @end deftypevr
11230
11231 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11232 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11233 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11234 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11235 @end deftypefn
11236
11237 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11238 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11239 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11240 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11241 @end deftypefn
11242
11243 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11244 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11245 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11246 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11247 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11248 @end deftypefn
11249
11250 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11251 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11252 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11253 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11254 the front end.
11255 @end deftypefn
11256
11257 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11258 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11259 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11260 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11261 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11262 @end deftypefn
11263
11264 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11265 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11266 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11267 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11268 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11269 @end deftypefn
11270
11271 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11272 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11273 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11274 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11275 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11276 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11277 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11278 @end deftypefn
11279
11280 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11281 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11282 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11283 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11284 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11285 conversion rules.
11286 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11287 @end deftypefn
11288
11289 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11290 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11291 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11292 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11293 @end defmac
11294
11295 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11296 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11297 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11298 @end defmac
11299
11300 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11301 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11302 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11303 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11304 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11305 @end defmac
11306
11307 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11308 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11309 necessary.
11310 @end deftypefn
11311
11312 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11313 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11314 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11315 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11316 is needed.
11317 @end deftypefn
11318
11319 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11320 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11321 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11322 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11323 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11324 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11325 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11326 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11327 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11328 @end deftypefn
11329
11330 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11331 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11332 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11333 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11334 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11335 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11336 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11337 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11338 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11339 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11340 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11341 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11342 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11343 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11344 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11345 is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr